target: add support for 64bit data in mem2array and array2mem
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @section Interface Drivers
2371
2372 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2373 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2374 available at run time.
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2377 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2378 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2379 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2380
2381 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2382 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2383 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2384 @end deffn
2385
2386 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2387 Displays status of RTCK option.
2388 Optionally sets that option first.
2389 @end deffn
2390 @end deffn
2391
2392 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2393 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2394 This has one driver-specific command:
2395
2396 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2397 Logs some status
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2402 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2403 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2404 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2405 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2406 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2410 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2411 or v2 (USB bulk).
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2414 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2415 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2416 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2417 @example
2418 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2419 @end example
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2423 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2424 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2428 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2429
2430 @itemize @minus
2431 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2432 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2433 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2434 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2435 @end itemize
2436 @end deffn
2437
2438 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2439 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2440 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2441 interface string or for user class interface.
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2445 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2446 @end deffn
2447 @end deffn
2448
2449 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2450 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2454 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2458 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2459 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2460
2461 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2462 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2463
2464 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2465 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2466
2467 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2468 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2469 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2470 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2471 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2472 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2473
2474 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2475 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2476 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2477 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2478 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2479
2480 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2481 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2482 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2483 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2484
2485 @itemize @minus
2486 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2487 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2488 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2489 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2490 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2491 switching data and direction as necessary
2492 @end itemize
2493
2494 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2495 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2496
2497 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2498 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2499 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2500 @example
2501 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2502 @end example
2503 @end deffn
2504
2505 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2506 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2507 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2508 during device selection.
2509 @end deffn
2510
2511 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2512 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2513 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2514 is connected to the host.
2515 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2516 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2517 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2521 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2522 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2526 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2527 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2528 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2529 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2530 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2531 and initially asserted reset signals.
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2535 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2536 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2537 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2538 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2539 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2540 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2541 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2542 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2543 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2544 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2545
2546 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2547 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2548 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2549 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2550 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2551 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2552
2553 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2554 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2555 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2556 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2557 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2558 are always driven by the FTDI.
2559
2560 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2561 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2562 @var{name}.
2563 @end deffn
2564
2565 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2566 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2567 @itemize @minus
2568 @item @option{0}, drive low
2569 @item @option{1}, drive high
2570 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2571 @end itemize
2572 @end deffn
2573
2574 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2575 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2579 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2580
2581 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2582 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2583 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2584 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2585 @itemize @minus
2586 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2587 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2588 @end itemize
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2592 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2593
2594 @end deffn
2595
2596 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2597 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2598 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2599 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2600
2601 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2602 @itemize @minus
2603 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2604 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2605 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2606 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2607 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2608 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2609 @end itemize
2610
2611 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2612 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2613 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2614 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2615 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2616 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2617 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2618 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2619
2620 FT232R
2621 @itemize @minus
2622 @item bit 7 - RI
2623 @item bit 6 - DCD
2624 @item bit 5 - DSR
2625 @item bit 4 - DTR
2626 @item bit 3 - CTS
2627 @item bit 2 - RTS
2628 @item bit 1 - RXD
2629 @item bit 0 - TXD
2630 @end itemize
2631
2632 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2633 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2636 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2637 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2641 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2642 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2643 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2644 @end deffn
2645
2646 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2647 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2648 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2649 @end deffn
2650
2651 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2652 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2656 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2660 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2664 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2668 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2669 @end deffn
2670
2671 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2672 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2676 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2677 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2678 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2679 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2680 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2681 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2682 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2683 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2684 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2685 @end deffn
2686
2687 @end deffn
2688
2689 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2690 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2691 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2692 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2693
2694 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2695 processors which are being simulated.
2696
2697 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2698 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2699 sockets instead of TCP.
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2703 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2704 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2705 @end deffn
2706
2707 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2708 something like:
2709
2710 @example
2711 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2712 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2713 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2714 @end example
2715
2716 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2717 named mysocket:
2718
2719 @example
2720 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2721 remote_bitbang_port 0
2722 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2723 @end example
2724 @end deffn
2725
2726 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2727 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2728 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2729 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2730
2731 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2732 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2733 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2734 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2735 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2736 @end deffn
2737
2738 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2739 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2740 default values are used.
2741 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2742 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2743 @example
2744 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2745 @end example
2746 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2747 @example
2748 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2749 @end example
2750 @end deffn
2751
2752 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2753 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2754 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2755 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2756 target board.
2757
2758 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2759 @example
2760 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2761 reset_config srst_only
2762 @end example
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2766 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2767 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2768 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2769 @end deffn
2770
2771 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2772 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2773 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2774 @end deffn
2775
2776 @end deffn
2777
2778 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2779 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2780 This has one driver-specific command:
2781
2782 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2783 Display either the address of the I/O port
2784 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2785 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2786 This is a write-once setting.
2787 @end deffn
2788 @end deffn
2789
2790 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2791 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2792 transports.
2793
2794 @quotation Compatibility Note
2795 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2796 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2797 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2798 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2799 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2800 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2801 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2802 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2803 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2804 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2805 @end quotation
2806
2807 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2808 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2809 states.
2810 @end deffn
2811 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2812 Display free device internal memory.
2813 @end deffn
2814 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2815 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2816 command version.
2817 @end deffn
2818 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2819 Display the device configuration.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2822 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2823 power state.
2824 @end deffn
2825 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2826 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2827 @end deffn
2828 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2829 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2830 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2831 IP configuration.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2834 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2835 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2836 @end deffn
2837 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2838 Reset the current configuration.
2839 @end deffn
2840 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2841 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2844 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2845 pairs.
2846
2847 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2848 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2849 @example
2850 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2851 @end example
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2854 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2855 pairs.
2856
2857 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2858 @example
2859 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2860 77a90000
2861 @end example
2862 @end deffn
2863 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2864 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2865 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2866 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2867 the serial number instead, if possible.
2868
2869 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2870 @end deffn
2871 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2872 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2873 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2874
2875 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2876 @end deffn
2877 @end deffn
2878
2879 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2880 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2881 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2882 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2883 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2884 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2885 configuration script.
2886
2887 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2888 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2889 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2890 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2891 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2892
2893 Known limitations:
2894 @itemize @bullet
2895 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2896 and 2.7 MHz.
2897 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2898 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2899 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2900 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2901 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2902 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2903 communications with the target.
2904 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2905 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2906 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2907 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2908 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2909 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2910 @end itemize
2911
2912 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2913 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2914 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2915 @end deffn
2916
2917 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2918 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2919 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2923 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2924 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2925 target as a side-effect.
2926 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2927 @end deffn
2928
2929 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2930 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2931 version, and target voltage.
2932 @end deffn
2933 @end deffn
2934
2935 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2936 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2937 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2938 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2939 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2940
2941 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2942 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2943 This is a write-once setting.
2944 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2945
2946 @itemize @minus
2947 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2948 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2949 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2950 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2951 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2952 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2953 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2954 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2955 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2956 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2957 some versions of
2958 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2959 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2960 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2961 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2962 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2963 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2964 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2965 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2966 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2967 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2968 @end itemize
2969 @end deffn
2970
2971 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2972 Display either the address of the I/O port
2973 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2974 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2975 This is a write-once setting.
2976
2977 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2978 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2979 you may encounter a problem.
2980 @end deffn
2981
2982 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2983 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2984 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2985 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2986 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2987 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2988
2989 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2990 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2991 @quotation Tip
2992 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2993 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2994 @example
2995 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2996 > adapter speed 500
2997 @end example
2998 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2999 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3000 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3001 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3002 large set of samples.
3003 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3004 @example
3005 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3006 @end example
3007 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3008 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3009
3010 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3011 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3012 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3013 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3014 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3015 be conservative.
3016 @end quotation
3017 @end deffn
3018
3019 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3020 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3021 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3022 @end deffn
3023
3024 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3025 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3026
3027 @example
3028 adapter driver parport
3029 parport_port 0x278
3030 parport_cable wiggler
3031 @end example
3032 @end deffn
3033
3034 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3035 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3036 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3037 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3038 @end deffn
3039 @end deffn
3040
3041 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3042 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3043 @end deffn
3044
3045 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3046 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3047 @end deffn
3048
3049 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3050 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3051
3052 @quotation Note
3053 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3054 which are not currently documented here.
3055 @end quotation
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @anchor{hla_interface}
3059 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3060 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3061 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3062 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3063
3064 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3065 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3066 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3067 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3068 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3069 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3070
3071 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3072 Currently Not Supported.
3073 @end deffn
3074
3075 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3076 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3077 @end deffn
3078
3079 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3080 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3081 @end deffn
3082
3083 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3084 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3088 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3089 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3090
3091 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3092 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3093 ST-LINK server software module}.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3097 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3098 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3099 @end deffn
3100 @end deffn
3101
3102 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3103 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3104 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3105 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3106 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3107
3108 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3109 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3110 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3111 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3112
3113 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3114 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3115
3116 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3117 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3118 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3119
3120 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3121 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3122 ST-LINK server software module}.
3123
3124 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3125 @end deffn
3126
3127 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3128 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3129 @end deffn
3130
3131 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3132 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3133 @end deffn
3134 @end deffn
3135
3136 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3137 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3138 @end deffn
3139
3140 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3141 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3145 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3146 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3147 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3148 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3149
3150 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3151 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3152 XDS110 found will be used.
3153 @end deffn
3154
3155 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3156 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3157 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3158 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3159 @end deffn
3160
3161 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3162 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3163 version).
3164 @end deffn
3165 @end deffn
3166
3167 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3168 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3169 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3170 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3171 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3172
3173 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3174
3175 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3176 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3177
3178 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3179 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3180
3181 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3182
3183 @end deffn
3184 @end deffn
3185
3186 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3187 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3188 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3189
3190 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3191 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3192 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3193 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3194 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3195 configuration on exit.
3196
3197 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3198 pinout.
3199
3200 @end deffn
3201
3202 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3203 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3204 of the one which is most popular.
3205
3206 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3207
3208 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3209 pinout.
3210
3211 @end deffn
3212
3213
3214 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3215 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3216 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3217
3218 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3219 @end deffn
3220
3221
3222 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3223 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3224 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3225
3226 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3227 @end deffn
3228
3229
3230 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3231 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3232 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3233
3234 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3235 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3236 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3237
3238 @itemize @minus
3239 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3240 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3241 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3242 @end itemize
3243 @end deffn
3244
3245 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3246 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3247 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3248 @end deffn
3249 @end deffn
3250
3251
3252 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3253 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3254 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3255 DPI server interface.
3256
3257 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3258 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3259 @end deffn
3260
3261 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3262 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3263 @end deffn
3264 @end deffn
3265
3266
3267 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3268
3269 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3270 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3271
3272 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3273 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3274
3275 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate_port} serial_port
3276 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3277 @example
3278 buspirate_port /dev/ttyUSB0
3279 @end example
3280 @end deffn
3281
3282 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate_speed} (normal|fast)
3283 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3284 @example
3285 buspirate_mode normal
3286 @end example
3287 @end deffn
3288
3289 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate_mode} (normal|open-drain)
3290 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3291 @itemize @minus
3292 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3293 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3294 @end itemize
3295 For example:
3296 @example
3297 buspirate_mode normal
3298 @end example
3299 @end deffn
3300
3301 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate_pullup} (0|1)
3302 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3303 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3304 For example:
3305 @example
3306 buspirate_pullup 0
3307 @end example
3308 @end deffn
3309
3310 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate_vreg} (0|1)
3311 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3312 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3313 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3314 @example
3315 buspirate_vreg 0
3316 @end example
3317 @end deffn
3318
3319 @deffn {Command} {buspirate_led} (0|1)
3320 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3321 @end deffn
3322 @example
3323 buspirate_led 1
3324 @end example
3325
3326 @end deffn
3327
3328
3329 @section Transport Configuration
3330 @cindex Transport
3331 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3332 and the debug adapter you are using,
3333 several transports may be available to
3334 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3335 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3336 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3337 version of OpenOCD.
3338 @end deffn
3339
3340 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3341 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3342
3343 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3344 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3345 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3346 adapter's driver).
3347
3348 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3349 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3350 supported by the debug adapter.
3351
3352 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3353 transport, if any.
3354 @end deffn
3355
3356 @subsection JTAG Transport
3357 @cindex JTAG
3358 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3359 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3360 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3361 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3362 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3363 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3364
3365 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3366 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3367 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3368 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3369 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3370
3371 @subsection SWD Transport
3372 @cindex SWD
3373 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3374 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3375 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3376 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3377 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3378 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3379 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3380
3381 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3382 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3383 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3384 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3385 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3386
3387 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3388 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3389 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3390 expected to change.
3391 @end deffn
3392 @deffn {Command} {swd wcr trn prescale}
3393 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3394 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3395 No parameters: displays current settings.
3396 @end deffn
3397
3398 @subsection SPI Transport
3399 @cindex SPI
3400 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3401 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3402 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3403 solution for flash programming.
3404
3405 @anchor{swimtransport}
3406 @subsection SWIM Transport
3407 @cindex SWIM
3408 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3409 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3410 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3411 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3412
3413 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3414
3415 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3416
3417 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3418 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3419 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3420 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3421 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3422
3423 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3424 @section JTAG Speed
3425 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3426 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3427 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3428 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3429 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3430 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3431 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3432 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3433 power management software that may be active.
3434
3435 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3436 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3437 target event handler.
3438 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3439 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3440 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3441 sets up those clocks).
3442 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3443 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3444 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3445 in the target config file.
3446 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3447 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3448 config file instead.
3449 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3450 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3451 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3452
3453 @example
3454 jtag_rclk 3000
3455 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3456 @end example
3457
3458 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3459 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3460 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3461 may not be the fastest solution.
3462
3463 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3464 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3465 which support adaptive clocking.
3466
3467 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3468 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3469 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3470 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3471 than the speed specified.
3472
3473 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3474 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3475 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3476 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3477
3478 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3479 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3480 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3481 JTAG clocking after setup.
3482 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3483 If the interface device can not
3484 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3485 @end deffn
3486
3487 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3488 @cindex adaptive clocking
3489 @cindex RTCK
3490 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3491 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3492 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3493 @example
3494 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3495 jtag_rclk 3000
3496 @end example
3497 @end defun
3498
3499 @node Reset Configuration
3500 @chapter Reset Configuration
3501 @cindex Reset Configuration
3502
3503 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3504 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3505 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3506 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3507 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3508 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3509 Please see the various board files for examples.
3510
3511 @quotation Note
3512 To maintainers and integrators:
3513 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3514 Normally the board configuration file
3515 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3516 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3517
3518 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3519 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3520 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3521 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3522 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3523 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3524 @end quotation
3525
3526 @section Types of Reset
3527
3528 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3529 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3530 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3531
3532 @itemize @bullet
3533 @item
3534 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3535 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3536 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3537 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3538 @item
3539 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3540 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3541 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3542 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3543 @item
3544 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3545 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3546 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3547 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3548 @item
3549 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3550 several other types of reset.
3551 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3552 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3553 There may be individual module resets.
3554 @end itemize
3555
3556 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3557 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3558 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3559 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3560 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3561 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3562 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3563 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3564 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3565
3566 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3567 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3568
3569 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3570 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3571 common issues are:
3572
3573 @itemize @bullet
3574
3575 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3576 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3577 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3578 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3579 when either of those signals is not connected.
3580 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3581 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3582 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3583 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3584
3585 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3586 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3587 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3588 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3589
3590 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3591 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3592 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3593 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3594 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3595 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3596 hardware debouncing.
3597 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3598 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3599
3600 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3601 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3602 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3603 to use push/pull output drivers.
3604 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3605 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3606 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3607 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3608
3609 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3610 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3611 issues (not limited to errata).
3612 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3613 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3614 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3615 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3616 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3617 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3618 @end itemize
3619
3620 There can also be other issues.
3621 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3622 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3623 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3624 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3625 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3626 Agreement (NDA).
3627
3628 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3629 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3630 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3631
3632 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3633 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3634
3635 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3636
3637 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3638 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3639 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3640 allowing it to be deasserted.
3641 @end deffn
3642
3643 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3644 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3645 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3646 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3647 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3648 @end deffn
3649
3650 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3651 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3652 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3653 allowing it to be deasserted.
3654 @end deffn
3655
3656 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3657 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3658 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3659 @end deffn
3660
3661 @anchor{reset_config}
3662 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3663 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3664 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3665 configuration scripts.
3666
3667 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3668 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3669 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3670 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3671 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3672 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3673 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3674 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3675
3676 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3677 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3678 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3679 -- may be specified at a time.
3680 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3681 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3682 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3683 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3684 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3685
3686 @itemize
3687 @item
3688 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3689 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3690 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3691 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3692 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3693
3694 @quotation Tip
3695 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3696 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3697 @end quotation
3698
3699 @item
3700 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3701 signal implementations.
3702 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3703 indicating everything behaves normally.
3704 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3705 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3706 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3707 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3708 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3709 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3710 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3711
3712 @item
3713 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3714 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3715 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3716 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3717 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3718 while SRST is asserted.
3719 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3720 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3721
3722 @item
3723 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3724 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3725 is required to use this option.
3726 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3727 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3728 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3729 be asserted before any target connection.
3730 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3731 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3732 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3733 @end itemize
3734
3735 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3736 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3737 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3738 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3739 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3740
3741 @itemize
3742 @item
3743 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3744 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3745 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3746 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3747
3748 @item
3749 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3750 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3751 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3752 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3753 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3754 @end itemize
3755 @end deffn
3756
3757 @section Custom Reset Handling
3758 @cindex events
3759
3760 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3761 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3762 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3763 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3764 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3765 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3766
3767 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3768 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3769 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3770 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3771 want to reset everything at once.
3772
3773 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3774 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3775 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3776 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3777 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3778 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3779 needs special attention.
3780
3781 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3782 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3783 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3784 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3785 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3786 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3787 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3788 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3789 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3790
3791 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3792 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3793 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3794 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3795 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3796
3797 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3798 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3799 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3800 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3801 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3802 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3803 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3804 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3805 or potentially some other value.
3806
3807 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3808 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3809 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3810 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3811 (or their associated targets)
3812 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3813
3814 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3815 they return.
3816 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3817 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3818 @end deffn
3819
3820 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3821 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3822 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3823 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3824 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3825 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3826 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3827 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3828 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3829 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3830 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3831 @end deffn
3832
3833 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3834 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3835 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3836 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3837 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3838 @end deffn
3839
3840
3841 @node TAP Declaration
3842 @chapter TAP Declaration
3843 @cindex TAP declaration
3844 @cindex TAP configuration
3845
3846 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3847 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3848
3849 @itemize @bullet
3850 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3851 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3852 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3853 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3854 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3855 start running that code.
3856 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3857 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3858 and missing connections.
3859 @end itemize
3860
3861 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3862 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3863 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3864 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3865 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3866
3867 @section Scan Chains
3868 @cindex scan chain
3869
3870 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3871 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3872 They also need to be added to
3873 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3874 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3875 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3876 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3877 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3878 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3879 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3880 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3881
3882 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3883 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3884 command, presented in the next chapter.
3885 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3886 debugging targets.)
3887 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3888
3889 @verbatim
3890 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3891 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3892 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3893 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3894 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3895 @end verbatim
3896
3897 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3898 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3899 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3900 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3901 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3902 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3903 until they are told to do so.
3904
3905 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3906 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3907 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3908 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3909
3910 @example
3911 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3912 @end example
3913
3914 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3915 by a given chip.
3916 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3917 and so forth.
3918 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3919 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3920 both inside a single chip and between them.
3921 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3922
3923 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3924 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3925 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3926 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3927 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3928 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3929 includes commands something like this:
3930
3931 @example
3932 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3933 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3934 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3935 @end example
3936
3937 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3938 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3939 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3940
3941 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
3942 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3943 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3944 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3945 @example
3946 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3947 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3948 @}
3949 @end example
3950 @end deffn
3951
3952 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
3953 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3954 and their status.
3955 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3956 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3957 but systems with a JTAG router can
3958 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3959 @end deffn
3960
3961 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3962 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3963
3964 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3965 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3966
3967 @section TAP Names
3968 @cindex dotted name
3969
3970 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3971 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3972 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3973 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3974 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3975 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3976 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3977 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3978
3979 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3980 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3981 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3982
3983 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3984
3985 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3986 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3987 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3988
3989 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3990 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3991 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3992 overridable.
3993
3994 @cindex TAP naming convention
3995 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3996 and should follow this convention:
3997
3998 @itemize @bullet
3999 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4000 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4001 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4002 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4003 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4004 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4005 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4006 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4007 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4008 with a single TAP;
4009 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4010 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4011 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4012 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4013 @end itemize
4014
4015 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4016
4017 @itemize @bullet
4018 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4019 @*The length in bits of the
4020 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4021 @end itemize
4022
4023 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4024
4025 @itemize @bullet
4026 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4027 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4028 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4029 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4030 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4031 (the TAP is linked in).
4032 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4033 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4034 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4035 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4036 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4037 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4038 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4039 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4040 values that were found but not included in the list.
4041
4042 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4043 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4044 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4045 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4046 hardware to find these values.
4047 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4048 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4049 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4050 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4051 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4052 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4053 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4054 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4055 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4056 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4057 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4058 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4059 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4060 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4061 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4062 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4063 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4064 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4065 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4066 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4067 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4068 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4069 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4070 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4071 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4072 @end itemize
4073 @end deffn
4074
4075 @section Other TAP commands
4076
4077 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4078 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4079 @end deffn
4080
4081 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4082 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4083 At this writing this TAP attribute
4084 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4085 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4086 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4087 See the next section for information about the available events.
4088
4089 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4090 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4091 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4092 @end deffn
4093
4094 @section TAP Events
4095 @cindex events
4096 @cindex TAP events
4097
4098 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4099 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4100 The other applies to debugger targets,
4101 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4102
4103 The TAP events currently defined are:
4104
4105 @itemize @bullet
4106 @item @b{post-reset}
4107 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4108 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4109 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4110 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4111 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4112
4113 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4114 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4115 of any particular target.
4116 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4117 @item @b{setup}
4118 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4119 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4120 @item @b{tap-disable}
4121 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4122 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4123 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4124 @item @b{tap-enable}
4125 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4126 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4127 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4128 @end itemize
4129
4130 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4131 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4132 contents to be accurate), you might:
4133
4134 @example
4135 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4136 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4137 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4138 @}
4139 @end example
4140
4141
4142 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4143 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4144 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4145 @cindex jrc
4146
4147 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4148 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4149 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4150 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4151 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4152
4153 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4154 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4155 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4156 be visible.
4157 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4158 ignores, such as:
4159
4160 @itemize
4161 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4162 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4163 TAPs receive new instructions.
4164 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4165 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4166 @end itemize
4167
4168 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4169 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4170 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4171 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4172
4173 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4174 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4175
4176 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4177 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4178 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4179 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4180 should define TAP event handlers using
4181 code that looks something like this:
4182
4183 @example
4184 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4185 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4186 @}
4187 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4188 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4189 @}
4190 @end example
4191
4192 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4193
4194 @example
4195 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4196 @end example
4197
4198 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4199 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4200 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4201 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4202
4203 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4204 If necessary, disables the tap
4205 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4206 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4207 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4208 and "0" if it is disabled.
4209 @end deffn
4210
4211 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4212 If necessary, enables the tap
4213 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4214 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4215 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4216 and "0" if it is disabled.
4217 @end deffn
4218
4219 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4220 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4221 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4222 and "0" if it is disabled.
4223
4224 @quotation Note
4225 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4226 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4227 @end quotation
4228 @end deffn
4229
4230 @anchor{autoprobing}
4231 @section Autoprobing
4232 @cindex autoprobe
4233 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4234
4235 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4236 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4237 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4238 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4239
4240 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4241 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4242 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4243 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4244 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4245 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4246 right when they come out of reset).
4247
4248 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4249
4250 @example
4251 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4252 reset_config trst_and_srst
4253 jtag_rclk 8
4254 @end example
4255
4256 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4257 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4258
4259 @enumerate
4260 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4261 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4262 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4263 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4264 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4265 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4266 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4267 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4268 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4269 that is discovered.
4270 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4271 register, it will report it.
4272 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4273 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4274 @end enumerate
4275
4276 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4277 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4278 that's a bit more complex:
4279
4280 @example
4281 clock speed 8 kHz
4282 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4283 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4284 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4285 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4286 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4287 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4288 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4289 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4290 @end example
4291
4292 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4293 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4294 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4295 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4296 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4297 and so forth.
4298
4299 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4300 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4301 @cindex DAP declaration
4302
4303 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4304 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4305 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4306 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4307 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4308
4309 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4310
4311 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4312 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4313 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4314 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4315 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4316
4317 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4318
4319 @itemize @bullet
4320 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4321 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4322 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4323 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4324 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4325 @end itemize
4326 @end deffn
4327
4328 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4329 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4330 for TCL scripting.
4331 @end deffn
4332
4333 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4334 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4335 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4336 @end deffn
4337
4338 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4339 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4340 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4341 initialization, too.
4342 @end deffn
4343
4344 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4345
4346 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4347 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4348 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4349 @end deffn
4350
4351 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4352 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4353 @end deffn
4354
4355 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4356 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4357 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4358 or set a new value @var{value}.
4359 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4360 @end deffn
4361
4362 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4363 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4364 @end deffn
4365
4366 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4367 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4368 value @var{value}.
4369
4370 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4371 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4372 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4373
4374 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4375 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4376 @end deffn
4377
4378 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4379 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4380 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4381 @end deffn
4382
4383 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4384 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4385 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4386 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4387 @end deffn
4388
4389 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4390 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4391
4392 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4393 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4394 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4395 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4396 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4397 for details.
4398
4399 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4400 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4401 the pattern:
4402 @example
4403 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4404 @end example
4405
4406 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4407 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4408 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4409 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4410 @example
4411 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4412 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4413 @end example
4414
4415 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4416 @example
4417 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4418 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4419 @end example
4420
4421 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4422 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4423
4424 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4425 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4426 example with a proper dap name:
4427 @example
4428 xxx.dap apcsw default
4429 @end example
4430 @end deffn
4431
4432 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4433 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4434 Disabled by default
4435 @end deffn
4436
4437
4438 @node CPU Configuration
4439 @chapter CPU Configuration
4440 @cindex GDB target
4441
4442 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4443 You can also access these targets without GDB
4444 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4445 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4446 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4447 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4448
4449 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4450 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4451
4452 @section Target List
4453 @cindex target, current
4454 @cindex target, list
4455
4456 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4457 where each member has a name.
4458 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4459 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4460 (plural!) command.
4461 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4462 look like with more than one:
4463 @verbatim
4464 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4465 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4466 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4467 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4468 @end verbatim
4469
4470 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4471 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4472 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4473 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4474 space seen by that current target.
4475 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4476 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4477 are examples; and there are many more.
4478
4479 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4480
4481 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4482 Returns the name of the current target.
4483 @end deffn
4484
4485 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4486 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4487 @example
4488 foreach t [target names] @{
4489 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4490 @}
4491 @end example
4492 @end deffn
4493
4494 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4495 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4496
4497 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4498 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4499 command names are singular.}
4500
4501 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4502 targets in a user friendly form.
4503
4504 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4505 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4506 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4507 @end deffn
4508
4509 @section Target CPU Types
4510 @cindex target type
4511 @cindex CPU type
4512
4513 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4514 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4515 when calling @command{target create}.
4516 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4517 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4518 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4519 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4520 what core-specific commands may be available
4521 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4522 and more.
4523
4524 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4525 since there's a command to list them.
4526
4527 @anchor{targettypes}
4528 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4529 Lists all supported target types.
4530 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4531
4532 @itemize @bullet
4533 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4534 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4535 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4536 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4537 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4538 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4539 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4540 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4541 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4542 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4543 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4544 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4545 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4546 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4547 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4548 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4549 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4550 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4551 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4552 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4553 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4554 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4555 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4556 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4557 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4558 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4559 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4560 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4561 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4562 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4563 support for new CPUs.
4564 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4565 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4566 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4567 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4568 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4569 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4570 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4571 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4572 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4573 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4574 @itemize @minus
4575 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4576 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4577 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4578 @end itemize
4579 And two debug interfaces cores:
4580 @itemize @minus
4581 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4582 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4583 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4584 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4585 @end itemize
4586 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4587 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4588 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4589 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4590 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4591 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4592 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4593 @end itemize
4594 @end deffn
4595
4596 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4597 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4598 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4599 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4600 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4601 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4602 reflect design generations;
4603 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4604 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4605
4606 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4607 @section Target Configuration
4608
4609 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4610 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4611 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4612 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4613 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4614
4615 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4616 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4617 optional parts.
4618 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4619 command, created as part of target creation.
4620
4621 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4622 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4623 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4624 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4625 to be much more board-specific.
4626 The key steps you use might look something like this
4627
4628 @example
4629 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4630 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4631 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4632 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4633 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4634 @end example
4635
4636 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4637 on-chip SRAM.
4638 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4639 writes to target memory;
4640 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4641 GDB memory checksumming;
4642 and more.
4643
4644 @quotation Warning
4645 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4646 inaccessible when application code
4647 (such as an operating system)
4648 enables or disables the MMU.
4649 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4650 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4651 easy access to other addresses needed.
4652 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4653 @end quotation
4654
4655 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4656 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4657 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4658 controllers.
4659 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4660 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4661 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4662
4663 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4664 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4665 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4666 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4667 purposes including additional configuration.
4668
4669 @itemize @bullet
4670 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4671 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4672 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4673 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4674
4675 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4676 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4677 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4678 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4679 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4680 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4681 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4682
4683 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4684 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4685 @end itemize
4686 @end deffn
4687
4688 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4689 The options accepted by this command may also be
4690 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4691 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4692 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4693
4694 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4695 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4696 and changing its endianness.
4697
4698 @itemize @bullet
4699
4700 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4701 used to access this target.
4702
4703 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4704 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4705 create and manage DAP instances.
4706
4707 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4708 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4709
4710 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4711 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4712 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4713 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4714 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4715 same event name assigns only one handler.
4716
4717 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4718 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4719
4720 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4721 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4722 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4723 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4724 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4725 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4726 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4727
4728 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4729 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4730 or virtual address is being used.
4731
4732 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4733 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4734
4735 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4736 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4737 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4738 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4739 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4740
4741 @anchor{rtostype}
4742 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4743 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4744 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4745 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4746 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4747 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4748
4749 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4750 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4751 access the target for debugging.
4752
4753 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4754 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4755 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4756 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4757
4758 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4759 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4760 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4761 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4762 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4763
4764 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4765 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4766 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4767 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4768 command @command{gdb_port}.
4769 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4770
4771 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4772 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4773 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4774 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4775 @end itemize
4776 @end deffn
4777
4778 @section Other $target_name Commands
4779 @cindex object command
4780
4781 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4782 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4783
4784 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4785 Once a button is created a button
4786 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4787 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4788 configure it like this:
4789
4790 @example
4791 # Create
4792 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4793 # Modify
4794 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4795 # Query
4796 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4797 # Report
4798 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4799 @end example
4800
4801 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4802 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4803
4804 @example
4805 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4806 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4807 @end example
4808
4809 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4810
4811 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4812 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4813 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4814 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4815 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4816 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4817 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4818 They are not otherwise documented here.
4819 @end deffn
4820
4821 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4822 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4823 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4824 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4825 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4826 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4827 the target side uses raw memory.
4828
4829 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4830 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4831 The script orientation comes from working with data
4832 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4833 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4834 and neither store nor return those values.
4835
4836 @itemize
4837 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4838 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4839 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4840 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4841 @end itemize
4842 @end deffn
4843
4844 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4845 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4846 @command{$target_name configure}
4847 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4848 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4849 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4850 There are a few special cases:
4851
4852 @itemize @bullet
4853 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4854 event named @var{event_name}.
4855 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4856 two parameters.
4857 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4858 This is a special case because this is set using
4859 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4860 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4861 @end itemize
4862
4863 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4864 all the targets you might use something like this:
4865
4866 @example
4867 foreach name [target names] @{
4868 set y [$name cget -endian]
4869 set z [$name cget -type]
4870 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4871 $x $name $y $z]
4872 @}
4873 @end example
4874 @end deffn
4875
4876 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4877 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4878 Displays the current target state:
4879 @code{debug-running},
4880 @code{halted},
4881 @code{reset},
4882 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4883 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4884 @end deffn
4885
4886 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4887 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4888 currently associated with this target.
4889 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4890 @end deffn
4891
4892 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4893 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4894 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4895 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4896 @end deffn
4897
4898 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4899 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4900 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4901 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4902 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4903 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4904 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4905 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4906 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4907 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4908 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4909 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4910 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4911 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4912 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4913 @end deffn
4914
4915 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4916 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4917 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4918 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4919 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4920 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4921 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4922 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4923 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4924 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4925 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4926 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4927 @end deffn
4928
4929 @anchor{targetevents}
4930 @section Target Events
4931 @cindex target events
4932 @cindex events
4933 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4934 For example:
4935 @itemize @bullet
4936 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4937 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4938 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4939 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4940 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4941 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4942 to set up system clocks or
4943 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4944 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4945 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4946 @end itemize
4947
4948 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4949 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4950 @command{target create ... -event}.
4951
4952 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4953 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4954 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4955
4956 @example
4957 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4958 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4959 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4960 @}
4961 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4962 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4963 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4964 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4965 @}
4966 @end example
4967
4968 The following target events are defined:
4969
4970 @itemize @bullet
4971 @item @b{debug-halted}
4972 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4973 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4974 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4975 @item @b{early-halted}
4976 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4977 @item @b{examine-start}
4978 @* Before target examine is called.
4979 @item @b{examine-end}
4980 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4981 @item @b{examine-fail}
4982 @* After target examine fails.
4983 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4984 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4985 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4986 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4987 connect GDB to running target.
4988 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4989 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4990 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4991 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4992 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4993 is in RAM or read only memory.
4994 Default is @code{halt}
4995 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4996 @* When GDB disconnects
4997 @item @b{gdb-end}
4998 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4999 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5000 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5001 @code{reset init})
5002 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5003 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5004 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5005 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5006 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5007 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5008 @item @b{gdb-start}
5009 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5010 @item @b{halted}
5011 @* The target has halted
5012 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5013 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5014 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5015 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5016 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5017 @item @b{reset-assert}
5018 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5019 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5020 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5021 it instead of asserting SRST.
5022 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5023 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5024 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5025 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5026 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5027 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5028 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5029 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5030 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5031 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5032 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5033 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5034 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5035 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5036 released on the scan chain.
5037 @item @b{reset-end}
5038 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5039 @item @b{reset-init}
5040 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5041 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5042
5043 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5044 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5045 multiplexing, and so on.
5046 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5047 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5048 @item @b{reset-start}
5049 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5050 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5051
5052 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5053 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5054 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5055 @item @b{resume-start}
5056 @* Before any target is resumed
5057 @item @b{resume-end}
5058 @* After all targets have resumed
5059 @item @b{resumed}
5060 @* Target has resumed
5061 @item @b{step-start}
5062 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5063 @item @b{step-end}
5064 @* After single-step has completed
5065 @item @b{trace-config}
5066 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5067 @end itemize
5068
5069 @quotation Note
5070 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5071 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5072 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5073 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5074 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5075 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5076 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5077 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5078 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5079 check if the core has changed status.
5080 @end quotation
5081
5082 @node Flash Commands
5083 @chapter Flash Commands
5084
5085 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5086 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5087 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5088 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5089 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5090 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5091 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5092 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5093 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5094
5095 Flash Steps:
5096 @enumerate
5097 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5098 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5099 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5100 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5101 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5102 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5103 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5104 @item GDB Flashing
5105 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5106 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5107 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5108 @end enumerate
5109
5110 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5111 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5112 so that it can't boot.
5113 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5114 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5115
5116 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5117 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5118 @cindex flash configuration
5119
5120 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5121 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5122 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5123 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5124 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5125 see the driver-specific documentation.
5126
5127 @itemize @bullet
5128 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5129 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5130 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5131 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5132 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5133 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5134 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5135 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5136 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5137 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5138 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5139 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5140 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5141 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5142 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5143 commands to the flash controller.
5144 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5145 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5146 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5147 for more information.
5148 @end itemize
5149 @quotation Note
5150 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5151 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5152 @end quotation
5153 @end deffn
5154
5155 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5156 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5157 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5158 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5159 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5160 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5161 @end deffn
5162
5163 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5164 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5165 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5166 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5167 @end deffn
5168
5169 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5170 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5171 depends on the flash type.
5172 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5173 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5174 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5175 but most don't bother.
5176 @end deffn
5177
5178 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5179
5180 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5181 begins.
5182
5183 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5184 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5185 until the programming session is finished.
5186
5187 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5188 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5189
5190 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5191
5192 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5193 @cindex flash erasing
5194 @cindex flash reading
5195 @cindex flash writing
5196 @cindex flash programming
5197 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5198
5199 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5200 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5201 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5202 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5203 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5204
5205 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5206 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5207 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5208 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5209 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5210
5211 @quotation Note
5212 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5213 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5214 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5215 back to a flash bank.
5216 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5217 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5218 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5219 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5220 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5221 @end quotation
5222
5223 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5224 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5225 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5226 disabled first.
5227 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5228 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5229 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5230
5231 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5232 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5233 up to and including @var{last}.
5234 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5235 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5236 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5237 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5238 @end deffn
5239
5240 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5241 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5242 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5243 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5244 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5245 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5246 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5247 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5248 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5249 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5250 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5251 before erase starts.
5252 @end deffn
5253
5254 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5255 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5256 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5257 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5258 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5259 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5260 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5261 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5262 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5263 before issuing this command.
5264 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5265 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5266 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5267 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5268 @end deffn
5269 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5270
5271 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5272 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5273 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5274 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5275 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5276 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5277 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5278 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5279 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5280 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5281 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5282 @end deffn
5283
5284 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5285 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5286 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5287 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5288 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5289 @end deffn
5290
5291 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5292 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5293 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5294 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5295 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5296 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5297 @end deffn
5298
5299 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5300 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5301 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5302 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5303 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5304 @end deffn
5305
5306 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5307 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5308 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5309 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5310 to the base address for each section in the image.
5311 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5312 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5313 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5314 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5315 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5316 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5317 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5318 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5319 each image section.
5320
5321 @quotation Warning
5322 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5323 data you want to preserve.
5324 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5325 sections might be erased with no notice.
5326 @itemize
5327 @item
5328 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5329 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5330 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5331 @item
5332 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5333 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5334 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5335 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5336 @end itemize
5337 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5338 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5339 @end quotation
5340
5341 @end deffn
5342
5343 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5344 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5345 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5346 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5347 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5348 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5349 ordinary memory reads.
5350 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5351 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5352 check for successful programming.
5353 @end deffn
5354
5355 @section Other Flash commands
5356 @cindex flash protection
5357
5358 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5359 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5360 and display that status.
5361 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5362 @end deffn
5363
5364 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5365 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5366 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5367
5368 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5369 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5370 and possibly stale information.
5371 @end deffn
5372
5373 @anchor{flashprotect}
5374 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5375 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5376 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5377 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5378 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5379 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5380 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5381 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5382 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5383 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5384 @end deffn
5385
5386 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5387 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5388 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5389 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5390 @end deffn
5391
5392 @anchor{program}
5393 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5394 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5395 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5396 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5397 @end deffn
5398
5399 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5400 @section Flash Driver List
5401 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5402 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5403 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5404
5405 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5406 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5407 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5408
5409 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5410
5411 @itemize
5412 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5413 @end itemize
5414
5415 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5416 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5417 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5418 @example
5419 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5420 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5421 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5422 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5423 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5424 @end example
5425 @end deffn
5426
5427 @subsection External Flash
5428
5429 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5430 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5431 @cindex CFI
5432 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5433 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5434 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5435 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5436 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5437 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5438 configure a bus and its timings), or
5439 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5440 on the flash chip.
5441 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5442 speed up operation.
5443
5444 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5445
5446 @itemize
5447 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5448 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5449 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5450 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5451 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5452 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5453 @end itemize
5454
5455 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5456 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5457
5458 @example
5459 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5460 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5461 @end example
5462
5463 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5464 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5465 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5466
5467 @example
5468 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5469 @end example
5470
5471 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5472 @end deffn
5473
5474 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5475 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5476 @cindex SPI
5477 @cindex jtagspi
5478 @cindex bscan_spi
5479 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5480 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5481 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5482 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5483 accessed through JTAG.
5484
5485 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5486 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5487 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5488 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5489 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5490 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5491
5492 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5493 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5494 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5495 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5496 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5497 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5498 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5499 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5500
5501 @itemize
5502 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5503 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5504 @var{USER1} instruction.
5505 @end itemize
5506
5507 @example
5508 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5509 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5510 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5511 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5512 @end example
5513 @end deffn
5514
5515 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5516 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5517 @cindex xcf
5518 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5519 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5520 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5521 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5522 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5523
5524 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5525 command accepts additional parameters:
5526 @itemize
5527 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5528 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5529 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5530 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5531 in master mode.
5532 @end itemize
5533 @example
5534 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5535 @end example
5536 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5537 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5538 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5539 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5540 dedicated sector.
5541 @end deffn
5542
5543 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5544 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5545 button.
5546 @example
5547 xcf configure 0
5548 @end example
5549 @end deffn
5550
5551 Additional driver notes:
5552 @itemize
5553 @item Only single revision supported.
5554 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5555 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5556 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5557 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5558 @end itemize
5559 @end deffn
5560
5561 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5562 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5563 @cindex SPIFI
5564 @cindex lpcspifi
5565 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5566 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5567 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5568
5569 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5570 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5571 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5572 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5573 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5574
5575 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5576 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5577 are configured by the driver.
5578
5579 @example
5580 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5581 @end example
5582
5583 @end deffn
5584
5585 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5586 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5587 @cindex SMI
5588 @cindex stmsmi
5589 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5590 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5591 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5592 SPI flash devices.
5593 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5594 flash devices can be connected.
5595
5596 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5597 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5598 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5599 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5600 the flash content.
5601
5602 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5603 to identify the memory bank.
5604 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5605 flash size, are detected automatically.
5606
5607 @example
5608 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5609 @end example
5610
5611 @end deffn
5612
5613 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5614 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5615 @cindex QuadSPI
5616 @cindex OctoSPI
5617 @cindex stmqspi
5618 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5619 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5620 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5621 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5622 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5623 mode is not.
5624
5625 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5626 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5627 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5628 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5629
5630 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5631 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5632 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5633
5634 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5635 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5636 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5637 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5638 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5639 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5640
5641 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5642 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5643 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5644 should be avoided.
5645
5646 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5647 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5648 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5649 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5650 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5651 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5652
5653 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5654 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5655 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5656 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5657 persist across openocd invocations.
5658
5659 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5660 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5661 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5662 required (see 'set' command).
5663
5664 @example
5665 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5666 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5667 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5668 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5669 @end example
5670
5671 There are three specific commands
5672 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5673 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5674 chip specific write protection engaged.
5675 @end deffn
5676
5677 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5678 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5679 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5680 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5681 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5682 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5683
5684 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5685 which don't support an id command.
5686
5687 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5688 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5689 @end deffn
5690
5691 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5692 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5693 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5694 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5695 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5696
5697 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5698 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5699 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5700 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5701
5702 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5703
5704 To check basic communication settings, issue
5705 @example
5706 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5707 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5708 @end example
5709 for single flash mode or
5710 @example
5711 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5712 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5713 @end example
5714 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5715
5716 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5717 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5718 need a dummy address, e.g.
5719 @example
5720 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5721 @end example
5722 should return the status register contents.
5723
5724 @end deffn
5725
5726 @end deffn
5727
5728 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5729 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5730 Microcontroller platform.
5731
5732 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5733 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5734
5735 @example
5736 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5737 @end example
5738
5739 @end deffn
5740
5741 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5742 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5743 @cindex ath79
5744 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5745 chip selects.
5746 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5747 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5748 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5749 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5750 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5751 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5752
5753 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5754 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5755 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5756 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5757 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5758 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5759 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5760 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5761 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5762 with the default CS0.
5763 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5764 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5765 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5766
5767 @example
5768 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5769
5770 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5771 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5772 # distinguish the banks.
5773 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5774 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5775 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5776 @end example
5777
5778 @end deffn
5779
5780 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5781 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5782 @cindex fespi
5783
5784 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5785
5786 @example
5787 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5788 @end example
5789 @end deffn
5790
5791 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5792
5793 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5794 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5795 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5796 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5797 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5798 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5799
5800 @example
5801 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5802 @end example
5803 @end deffn
5804
5805 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5806 @cindex ambiqmicro
5807 @cindex apollo
5808 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5809 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5810 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5811 with the target using SWD.
5812
5813 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5814 the device class of the MCU.
5815 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5816 to set up the flash banks.
5817 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5818 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5819
5820 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5821 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5822 and the second bank starts after the first.
5823
5824 @example
5825 # Flash bank 0
5826 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5827 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5828 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5829 $_TARGETNAME
5830 @end example
5831
5832 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5833 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5834 are available to the user.
5835
5836 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5837
5838 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5839 Erase entire bank.
5840 @end deffn
5841 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5842 Erase device pages.
5843 @end deffn
5844 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5845 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5846 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5847 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5848 the flash.
5849 @end deffn
5850 @end deffn
5851
5852 @anchor{at91samd}
5853 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5854 @cindex at91samd
5855 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5856 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5857
5858 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5859
5860 The devices have one flash bank:
5861
5862 @example
5863 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5864 @end example
5865
5866 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5867 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5868 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5869 processor to be halted.
5870 @end deffn
5871
5872 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5873 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5874 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5875 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5876 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5877 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5878
5879 @example
5880 at91samd set-security enable
5881 @end example
5882 @end deffn
5883
5884 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5885 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5886 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5887 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5888 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5889 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5890 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5891 in order to disable this feature.
5892
5893 @example
5894 at91samd eeprom
5895 at91samd eeprom 1024
5896 @end example
5897 @end deffn
5898
5899 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
5900 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5901 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5902 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5903 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5904 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5905
5906 @example
5907 at91samd bootloader
5908 at91samd bootloader 16384
5909 @end example
5910 @end deffn
5911
5912 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5913 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5914 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5915 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5916 @end deffn
5917
5918 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5919 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5920 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5921 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5922 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5923 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5924 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5925 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5926
5927 @example
5928 # Read user row
5929 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5930 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5931 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5932 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5933 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
5934 # byte unchanged
5935 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5936 @end example
5937 @end deffn
5938
5939 @end deffn
5940
5941 @anchor{at91sam3}
5942 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
5943 @cindex at91sam3
5944 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5945 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5946 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5947 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5948 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5949 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5950 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5951 chips are confirmed.}
5952
5953 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5954 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5955 the following fixed locations:
5956
5957 @example
5958 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5959 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5960 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5961 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5962 @end example
5963
5964 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5965 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5966 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5967
5968 @itemize
5969 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5970 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5971 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5972 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5973 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5974 @end itemize
5975
5976 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5977
5978 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5979 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5980 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5981 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5982 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5983 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5984 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5985
5986 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5987 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5988 @end deffn
5989
5990 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
5991 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5992 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5993 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5994 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5995 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5996 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5997 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5998 @end deffn
5999
6000 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6001 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6002 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6003 @end deffn
6004 @end deffn
6005
6006 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6007 @cindex at91sam4
6008 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6009 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6010 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6011 @end deffn
6012
6013 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6014 @cindex at91sam4l
6015 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6016 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6017 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6018
6019 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6020 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6021 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6022 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6023 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6024 @end deffn
6025 @end deffn
6026
6027 @anchor{atsame5}
6028 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6029 @cindex atsame5
6030 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6031 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6032 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6033
6034 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6035 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6036 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6037
6038 @example
6039 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6040 @end example
6041
6042 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6043 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6044 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6045 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6046 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6047 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6048
6049 @example
6050 atsame5 bootloader
6051 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6052 @end example
6053 @end deffn
6054
6055 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6056 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6057 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6058 processor to be halted.
6059 @end deffn
6060
6061 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6062 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6063 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6064 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6065 @end deffn
6066
6067 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6068 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6069 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6070 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6071 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6072 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6073 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6074 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6075
6076 @example
6077 # Read
6078 >atsame5 userpage
6079 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6080 # Write
6081 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6082 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6083 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6084 # bytes)
6085 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6086 @end example
6087 @end deffn
6088
6089 @end deffn
6090
6091 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6092 @cindex atsamv
6093 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6094 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6095 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6096 @end deffn
6097
6098 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6099 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6100 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6101 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6102 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6103
6104 @example
6105 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6106 @end example
6107
6108 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6109 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6110
6111 @itemize
6112 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6113 @item @var{banks}
6114 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6115 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6116 @item @var{pages_size}
6117 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6118 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6119 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6120 @end itemize
6121
6122 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6123 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6124 will be autoconfigured.
6125 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6126
6127 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6128 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6129 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6130 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6131 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6132
6133 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6134 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6135 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6136 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6137 are not truly general purpose).
6138 @quotation Note
6139 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6140 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6141 @end quotation
6142 @end deffn
6143 @end deffn
6144
6145 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6146 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6147 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6148 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6149 @end deffn
6150
6151 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6152 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6153 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6154 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6155
6156 @example
6157 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6158 @end example
6159
6160 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6161 each single sector one by one.
6162
6163 @example
6164 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6165 @end example
6166
6167 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6168 @end deffn
6169
6170 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6171 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6172 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6173 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6174 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6175 starts at address 0.
6176
6177 @example
6178 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6179 @end example
6180 @end deffn
6181
6182 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6183 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6184 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6185 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6186 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6187 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6188 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6189 and programming the serial flash.
6190
6191 @example
6192 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6193 @end example
6194 @end deffn
6195
6196 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6197 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6198 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6199 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6200 autoconfigures itself.
6201 @example
6202 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6203 @end example
6204 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6205 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6206 this via the following command:
6207 @example
6208 efm32 debuglock num
6209 @end example
6210 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6211 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6212 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6213 supported.}
6214 @end deffn
6215
6216 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6217 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6218 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6219 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6220 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6221 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6222
6223 @example
6224 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6225 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6226 @end example
6227
6228 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6229 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6230 @end deffn
6231
6232 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6233 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6234 is an uncommon operation.}
6235 @end deffn
6236 @end deffn
6237
6238 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6239 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6240 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6241 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6242 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6243 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6244 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6245
6246 @example
6247 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6248 @end example
6249 @end deffn
6250
6251 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6252 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6253 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6254 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6255 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6256 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6257 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6258 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6259 characters) ignored.
6260
6261 @example
6262 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6263 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6264 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6265 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6266 @end example
6267 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6268 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6269 @end deffn
6270
6271 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6272 @cindex kinetis
6273 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6274 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6275 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6276 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6277 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6278 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6279
6280 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6281 @itemize
6282 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6283 @end itemize
6284
6285 @example
6286 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6287 @end example
6288
6289 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6290 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6291 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6292 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6293 @end deffn
6294
6295 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6296 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6297 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6298 set by 'flash protect' command.
6299 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6300 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6301 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6302 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6303 with the rest of a flash image.
6304 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6305 @end deffn
6306
6307 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6308 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6309 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6310 @end deffn
6311
6312 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6313 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6314 and examine-fail event.
6315 @end deffn
6316
6317 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6318 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6319 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6320 @end deffn
6321
6322 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6323 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6324 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6325 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6326 command completes.
6327 @end deffn
6328
6329 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6330 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6331 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6332 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6333 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6334
6335 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6336 Program Partition command.
6337
6338 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6339 Reset the device after partition setting.
6340
6341 Show partition size:
6342 @example
6343 kinetis nvm_partition info
6344 @end example
6345
6346 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6347 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6348 @example
6349 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6350 @end example
6351
6352 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6353 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6354 @example
6355 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6356 @end example
6357 @end deffn
6358
6359 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6360 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6361 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6362 @end deffn
6363
6364 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6365 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6366 Command disables watchdog timer.
6367 @end deffn
6368 @end deffn
6369
6370 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6371 @cindex kinetis_ke
6372 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6373 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6374 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6375 autoconfigures itself.
6376 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6377
6378 @example
6379 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6380 @end example
6381
6382 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6383 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6384 @end deffn
6385
6386 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6387 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6388 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6389 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6390 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6391 @end deffn
6392
6393 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6394 Command disables watchdog timer.
6395 @end deffn
6396 @end deffn
6397
6398 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6399 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6400 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6401 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6402 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6403
6404 @quotation Note
6405 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6406 driver:
6407 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6408 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6409 @end quotation
6410
6411 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6412 which must appear in the following order:
6413
6414 @itemize
6415 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6416 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6417 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6418 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6419 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6420 LPC43x[2357])
6421 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6422 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6423 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6424 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6425 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6426 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6427 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6428 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6429 at which the core is running
6430 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6431 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6432 @quotation Note
6433 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6434 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6435 However, if you do provide it,
6436 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6437 @end quotation
6438 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6439 ROM IAP entry point.
6440 @end itemize
6441
6442 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6443
6444 @example
6445 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6446 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6447 @end example
6448
6449 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6450 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6451 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6452 @end deffn
6453 @end deffn
6454
6455 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6456 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6457 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6458 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6459 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6460 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6461
6462 @example
6463 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6464 @end example
6465 @end deffn
6466
6467 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6468 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6469 from NXP.
6470
6471 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6472 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6473 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6474 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6475 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6476 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6477 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6478 you start the PLL.
6479
6480 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6481
6482 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6483 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6484 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6485
6486 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6487 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6488 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6489 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6490 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6491 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6492 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6493
6494 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6495 @example
6496 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6497 @end example
6498
6499 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6500 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6501 @code{flash banks} command.
6502
6503 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6504 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6505 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6506 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6507 a known signature.
6508 Example:
6509 @example
6510 lpc2900 signature 0
6511 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6512 @end example
6513 @end deffn
6514
6515 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6516 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6517 saves it to a file in binary format.
6518 Example:
6519 @example
6520 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6521 @end example
6522 @end deffn
6523
6524 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6525 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6526 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6527 command:
6528
6529 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6530 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6531 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6532 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6533
6534 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6535 Example:
6536 @example
6537 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6538 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6539 @end example
6540 @end deffn
6541
6542 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6543 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6544 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6545 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6546 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6547 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6548 912 bytes.
6549 @quotation Attention
6550 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6551 @end quotation
6552 Example:
6553 @example
6554 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6555 @end example
6556 @end deffn
6557
6558 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6559 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6560 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6561 after the next power cycle.
6562 @quotation Attention
6563 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6564 @end quotation
6565 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6566 Example:
6567 @example
6568 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6569 flash info 0
6570 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6571 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6572 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6573 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6574 @end example
6575 @end deffn
6576
6577 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6578 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6579 effective after the next power cycle.
6580 @quotation Attention
6581 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6582 @end quotation
6583 Examples:
6584 @example
6585 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6586 @end example
6587 @end deffn
6588 @end deffn
6589
6590 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6591 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6592 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6593 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6594
6595 @example
6596 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6597 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6598 @end example
6599
6600 @itemize @bullet
6601 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6602 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6603 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6604 @end itemize
6605
6606 Example usage:
6607 @example
6608 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6609 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6610 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6611 @} else @{
6612 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6613 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6614 @}
6615 @end example
6616 @end deffn
6617
6618 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6619 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6620 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6621 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6622 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6623 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6624
6625 @example
6626 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6627 @end example
6628
6629 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6630 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6631 only the main program flash.
6632
6633 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6634 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6635 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6636 @end deffn
6637
6638 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6639 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6640 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6641 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6642
6643 To erase and program the BSL:
6644 @example
6645 msp432 bsl unlock
6646 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6647 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6648 msp432 bsl lock
6649 @end example
6650 @end deffn
6651 @end deffn
6652
6653 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6654 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6655 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6656 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6657 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6658 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6659 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6660 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6661 also have division into regions: main and info.
6662 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6663 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6664
6665 @example
6666 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6667 @end example
6668
6669 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6670
6671 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6672 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6673 @end deffn
6674
6675 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6676 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6677 @end deffn
6678
6679 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6680 Erase all userflash including info region.
6681 @end deffn
6682
6683 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6684 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6685 @end deffn
6686
6687 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6688 Check sectors protect.
6689 @end deffn
6690
6691 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6692 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6693 @end deffn
6694
6695 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6696 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6697 @end deffn
6698
6699 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6700 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6701 @end deffn
6702
6703 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6704 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6705 @end deffn
6706
6707 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6708 Show information about flash driver.
6709 @end deffn
6710
6711 @end deffn
6712
6713 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6714 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6715 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6716 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6717 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6718
6719 @example
6720 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6721 @end example
6722
6723 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6724
6725 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6726 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6727 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6728 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6729 code.
6730 @end deffn
6731
6732 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6733 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6734 @end deffn
6735
6736 @end deffn
6737
6738 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6739 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6740 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6741
6742 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6743 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6744 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6745 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6746
6747 @example
6748 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6749 @end example
6750 @end deffn
6751
6752 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6753 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6754 and integrate flash memory.
6755
6756 @example
6757 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6758 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6759 @end example
6760
6761 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6762 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6763 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6764 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6765 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6766 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6767 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6768 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6769 @end deffn
6770 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6771 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6772 This will remove any Code Protection.
6773 @end deffn
6774 @end deffn
6775
6776 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6777 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6778 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6779 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6780 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6781
6782 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6783 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6784
6785 @example
6786 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6787 @end example
6788
6789 psoc4-specific commands
6790 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6791 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6792
6793 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6794 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6795
6796 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6797 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6798 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6799
6800 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6801 @end deffn
6802
6803 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6804 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6805
6806 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6807 @end deffn
6808 @end deffn
6809
6810 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6811 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6812 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6813 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6814 apart from the base address.
6815
6816 @example
6817 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6818 @end example
6819
6820 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6821 @quotation Attention
6822 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6823 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6824 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6825 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6826 @end quotation
6827
6828 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6829
6830 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6831 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6832 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6833 @end deffn
6834 @end deffn
6835
6836 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6837 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6838 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6839 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6840 apart from the base address.
6841
6842 @example
6843 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6844 $_TARGETNAME
6845 @end example
6846 @end deffn
6847
6848 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6849 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6850 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6851 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6852
6853 @example
6854 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6855 @end example
6856
6857 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6858
6859 @itemize
6860 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6861 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6862 @end itemize
6863
6864 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6865
6866 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6867 @quotation Attention
6868 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6869 after successful write.
6870 @end quotation
6871 @end deffn
6872
6873 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
6874 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6875 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6876 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6877
6878 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6879 @itemize @bullet
6880 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6881 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6882 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6883 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6884 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6885 row size: 512 bytes.
6886 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6887 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6888 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6889 operation will erase row automatically.
6890 @end itemize
6891
6892 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6893 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6894
6895 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6896
6897 @example
6898 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6899 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6900 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6901 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6902 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6903 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6904 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6905 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6906 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6907 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6908 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6909 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6910
6911 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6912 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6913 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6914 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6915 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6916 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6917 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6918 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6919 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6920 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6921 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6922 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6923 @end example
6924
6925 psoc6-specific commands
6926 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
6927 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6928 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6929 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6930 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6931 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6932 @end deffn
6933
6934 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6935 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6936 by @command{flash banks}.
6937 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6938 @end deffn
6939 @end deffn
6940
6941 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
6942 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
6943 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
6944 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
6945 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
6946
6947 @example
6948 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
6949 @end example
6950 @end deffn
6951
6952 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
6953 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6954 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6955 and SWD interface.
6956 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6957 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6958
6959 @example
6960 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6961 @end example
6962
6963 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6964
6965 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
6966 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6967 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6968 @end deffn
6969
6970 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
6971 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6972 @end deffn
6973 @end deffn
6974
6975 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
6976 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6977 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6978 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6979 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6980
6981 @example
6982 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6983 @end example
6984
6985 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
6986 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6987 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6988 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6989 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6990 disabled.
6991
6992 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6993 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6994 @quotation Warning
6995 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6996 applied to all of them.
6997 @end quotation
6998 @end deffn
6999 @end deffn
7000
7001 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7002 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7003 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0 and GD32F3x0 microcontroller
7004 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
7005 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7006 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7007
7008 @example
7009 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7010 @end example
7011
7012 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7013 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7014 the flash driver.
7015
7016 @example
7017 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7018 @end example
7019
7020 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7021 as per the following example.
7022 @example
7023 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7024 @end example
7025
7026 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7027
7028 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7029 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7030 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7031 @end deffn
7032
7033 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7034 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7035 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7036 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7037 @end deffn
7038
7039 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7040 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7041 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7042 @end deffn
7043
7044 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7045 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7046 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7047 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7048 @end deffn
7049
7050 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7051 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7052 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7053 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7054 @end deffn
7055
7056 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7057 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7058 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7059 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7060 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7061 @end deffn
7062 @end deffn
7063
7064 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7065 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7066 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7067 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7068 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7069
7070 @example
7071 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7072 @end example
7073
7074 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7075 as per the following example.
7076 @example
7077 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7078 @end example
7079
7080 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7081 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7082 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7083 @end deffn
7084
7085 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7086 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7087 the flash driver.
7088
7089 @example
7090 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7091 @end example
7092
7093 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7094
7095 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7096 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7097 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7098 @end deffn
7099
7100 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7101 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7102 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7103 @end deffn
7104
7105 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7106 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7107 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7108 @end deffn
7109
7110 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7111 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7112 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7113 @end deffn
7114
7115 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7116 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7117 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7118 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7119 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7120 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7121 @end deffn
7122
7123 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7124 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7125 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7126 @end deffn
7127 @end deffn
7128
7129 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7130 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7131 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7132 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7133 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7134
7135 @example
7136 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7137 @end example
7138
7139 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7140 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7141 the flash driver.
7142
7143 @example
7144 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7145 @end example
7146
7147 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7148
7149 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7150 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7151 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7152 @end deffn
7153
7154 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7155 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7156 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7157 @end deffn
7158
7159 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7160 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7161 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7162 @end deffn
7163
7164 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7165 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7166 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7167 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7168 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7169
7170 Example usage:
7171 @example
7172 # read OPTSR_CUR
7173 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7174 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7175 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7176 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7177 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7178 @end example
7179 @end deffn
7180
7181 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7182 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7183 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7184 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7185 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7186 will be touched).
7187
7188 Example usage:
7189 @example
7190 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7191 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7192 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7193 @end example
7194 @end deffn
7195 @end deffn
7196
7197 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7198 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7199 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7200 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7201 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7202
7203 @example
7204 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7205 @end example
7206
7207 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7208 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7209 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7210 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7211 second bank.
7212
7213 @example
7214 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7215 @end example
7216
7217 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7218
7219 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7220 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7221 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7222 @end deffn
7223
7224 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7225 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7226 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7227 @end deffn
7228
7229 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7230 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7231 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7232 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7233 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7234 @end deffn
7235 @end deffn
7236
7237 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7238 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
7239 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7240 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7241 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7242 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7243
7244 @example
7245 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7246 @end example
7247
7248 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7249 as per the following example.
7250 @example
7251 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7252 @end example
7253
7254 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7255 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7256 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7257 @end deffn
7258
7259 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7260 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7261 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7262 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7263
7264 @example
7265 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7266 @end example
7267
7268 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7269
7270 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7271 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7272 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7273 @end deffn
7274
7275 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7276 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7277 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7278 @end deffn
7279
7280 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7281 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7282 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7283 @end deffn
7284
7285 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7286 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7287 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7288 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7289
7290 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7291 @example
7292 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7293 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7294 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7295 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7296 @end example
7297
7298 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7299 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7300 @end deffn
7301
7302 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7303 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7304 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7305 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7306 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7307
7308 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7309 @example
7310 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7311 @end example
7312
7313 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7314 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7315 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7316 @end deffn
7317
7318 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7319 List the protected areas using WRP.
7320 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7321 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7322 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7323
7324 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7325 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7326 in single or dual-banks mode.
7327 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7328 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7329
7330 @end deffn
7331
7332 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7333 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7334 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7335 @end deffn
7336 @end deffn
7337
7338 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7339 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7340 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7341 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7342 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7343
7344 @example
7345 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7346 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7347 @end example
7348
7349 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7350 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7351 for the specified flash bank.
7352 @end deffn
7353 @end deffn
7354
7355 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7356 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7357 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7358 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7359 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7360
7361 @example
7362 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7363 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7364 @end example
7365
7366 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7367 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7368 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7369
7370 @itemize @bullet
7371 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7372 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7373 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7374 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7375 @end itemize
7376 @end deffn
7377
7378 @end deffn
7379
7380 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7381 @cindex str9xpec
7382
7383 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7384 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7385 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7386 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7387
7388 Here is some background info to help
7389 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7390 the str9:
7391 @enumerate
7392 @item
7393 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7394 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7395 @item
7396 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7397 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7398 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7399 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7400 @end enumerate
7401
7402 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7403 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7404 configured for flash bank 0.
7405 @example
7406 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7407 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7408 adapter assert srst
7409 # turn off target polling
7410 poll off
7411 # disable str9 core
7412 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7413 # read option bytes
7414 str9xpec options_read 0
7415 # re-enable str9 core
7416 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7417 poll on
7418 reset halt
7419 @end example
7420 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7421 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7422 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7423 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7424
7425 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7426
7427 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7428 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7429 @end deffn
7430
7431 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7432 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7433 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7434 @end deffn
7435
7436 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7437 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7438 erase the device.
7439 @end deffn
7440
7441 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7442 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7443 @end deffn
7444
7445 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7446 Configure str9 boot bank.
7447 @end deffn
7448
7449 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7450 Configure str9 lvd source.
7451 @end deffn
7452
7453 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7454 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7455 @end deffn
7456
7457 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7458 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7459 @end deffn
7460
7461 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7462 Read str9 option bytes.
7463 @end deffn
7464
7465 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7466 Write str9 option bytes.
7467 @end deffn
7468
7469 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7470 unlock str9 device.
7471 @end deffn
7472
7473 @end deffn
7474
7475 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7476 @cindex swm050
7477 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7478
7479 @example
7480 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7481 @end example
7482
7483 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7484
7485 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7486 Erases the entire flash bank.
7487 @end deffn
7488
7489 @end deffn
7490
7491
7492 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7493 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7494 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7495 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7496
7497 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7498
7499 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7500 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7501 @end deffn
7502
7503 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7504 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7505 @end deffn
7506
7507 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7508 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7509 the flash clock.
7510 @end deffn
7511 @end deffn
7512
7513 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7514 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7515 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7516 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7517 correct bank config.
7518
7519 @example
7520 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7521 @end example
7522 @end deffn
7523
7524 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7525 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7526 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7527 @end deffn
7528
7529 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7530 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7531 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7532
7533 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7534
7535 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7536 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7537 @end deffn
7538
7539 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7540 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7541 @end deffn
7542
7543 @end deffn
7544
7545 @section NAND Flash Commands
7546 @cindex NAND
7547
7548 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7549 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7550 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7551
7552 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7553 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7554 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7555 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7556 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7557 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7558
7559 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7560 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7561 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7562 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7563 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7564 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7565 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7566 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7567 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7568 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7569
7570 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7571 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7572 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7573 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7574 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7575 every 512 bytes of data.
7576
7577 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7578 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7579 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7580 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7581 ECC mode is used.
7582
7583 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7584 @enumerate
7585 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7586 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7587 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7588 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7589 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7590 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7591 to access that device.
7592 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7593 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7594 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7595 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7596 de-brick a board.
7597 @end enumerate
7598
7599 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7600 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7601 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7602 are only 32 bits wide.
7603 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7604 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7605 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7606 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7607
7608 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7609 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7610 @cindex NAND configuration
7611
7612 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7613 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7614 OpenOCD has initialized.
7615
7616 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7617 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7618 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7619 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7620 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7621 they were a single (larger) device.
7622 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7623 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7624
7625 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7626 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7627 configuration files, not interactively.
7628
7629 @itemize @bullet
7630 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7631 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7632 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7633 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7634 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7635 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7636 commands to the NAND controller.
7637 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7638 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7639 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7640 for more information.
7641 @end itemize
7642 @end deffn
7643
7644 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7645 Prints a summary of each device declared
7646 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7647 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7648 @example
7649 > nand list
7650 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7651 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7652 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7653 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7654 >
7655 @end example
7656 @end deffn
7657
7658 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7659 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7660 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7661 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7662 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7663 it with most other NAND commands.
7664 @end deffn
7665
7666 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7667
7668 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7669 @cindex NAND reading
7670 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7671 starting at the specified offset.
7672 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7673
7674 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7675 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7676
7677 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7678 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7679 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7680
7681 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7682 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7683 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7684 method which handled that error correction.
7685
7686 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7687 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7688 @itemize @bullet
7689 @item no oob_* parameter
7690 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7691 @item @code{oob_raw}
7692 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7693 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7694 spare areas associated with each data page.
7695 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7696 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7697 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7698 @item @code{oob_only}
7699 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7700 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7701 spare areas associated with each data page.
7702 @end itemize
7703 @end deffn
7704
7705 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7706 @cindex NAND erasing
7707 @cindex NAND programming
7708 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7709 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7710 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7711 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7712 If those parameters are not specified,
7713 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7714 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7715
7716 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7717 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7718 block marker.
7719 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7720 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7721 @end deffn
7722
7723 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7724 @cindex NAND writing
7725 @cindex NAND programming
7726 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7727 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7728 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7729 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7730
7731 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7732 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7733
7734 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7735 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7736 past the end of the device.
7737 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7738 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7739 if that's being written.)
7740
7741 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7742 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7743 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7744
7745 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7746 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7747 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7748 @itemize @bullet
7749 @item no oob_* parameter
7750 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7751 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7752 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7753 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7754 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7755 @item @code{oob_only}
7756 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7757 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7758 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7759 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7760 @item @code{oob_raw}
7761 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7762 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7763 un-altered OOB.
7764 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7765 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7766 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7767 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7768 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7769 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7770 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7771 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7772 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7773 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7774 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7775 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7776 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7777 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7778 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7779 @end itemize
7780 @end deffn
7781
7782 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7783 @cindex NAND verification
7784 @cindex NAND programming
7785 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7786 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7787 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7788
7789 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7790 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7791
7792 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7793 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7794 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7795 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7796 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7797
7798 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7799 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7800 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7801
7802 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7803 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7804 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7805 be removed in a future release.
7806 @end deffn
7807
7808 @subsection Other NAND commands
7809 @cindex NAND other commands
7810
7811 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7812 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7813 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7814 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7815 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7816 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7817 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7818 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7819
7820 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7821 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7822 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7823 @end deffn
7824
7825 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7826 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7827 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7828 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7829 status for each block.
7830 @end deffn
7831
7832 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7833 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7834 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7835
7836 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7837 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7838 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7839 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7840 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7841
7842 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7843 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7844 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7845 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7846 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7847 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7848 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7849 @end deffn
7850
7851 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7852 @subsection NAND Driver List
7853 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7854 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7855 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7856
7857 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7858 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7859 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7860 address of the ECC controller.
7861 @example
7862 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7863 @end example
7864 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7865 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7866 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7867 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7868 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7869 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7870 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7871 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7872 @end deffn
7873 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7874 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7875 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7876 @end deffn
7877
7878 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7879 properly configured for input or output.
7880 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7881 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7882 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7883 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7884 @end deffn
7885 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7886 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7887 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7888 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7889 @end deffn
7890 @end deffn
7891
7892 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
7893 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7894 chips from Texas Instruments.
7895 It takes three extra parameters:
7896 address of the NAND chip;
7897 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7898 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7899 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7900 @example
7901 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7902 @end example
7903 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7904 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7905 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7906 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7907 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7908 @end deffn
7909
7910 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
7911 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7912 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7913 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7914 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7915 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7916 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7917 @end deffn
7918
7919 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7920 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7921 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7922 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7923 @end deffn
7924 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7925
7926 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
7927 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7928 should work for this chip as well.
7929 @end deffn
7930
7931 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
7932 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7933 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7934 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7935 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7936 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7937 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7938 @example
7939 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7940 @end example
7941 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7942 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7943 without parameter query status.
7944 @end deffn
7945 @end deffn
7946
7947 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
7948 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7949 parameter: the address of the controller.
7950 @example
7951 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7952 @end example
7953 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7954 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7955 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7956 change any behavior.
7957 @end deffn
7958
7959 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
7960 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
7961 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
7962 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
7963 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
7964 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7965 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7966 specialized commands.
7967 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7968 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7969 change any behavior.
7970 @end deffn
7971
7972 @node Flash Programming
7973 @chapter Flash Programming
7974
7975 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7976 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7977 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7978
7979 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7980 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7981
7982 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7983 @enumerate
7984 @item 'init' is executed.
7985 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7986 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7987 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7988 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7989 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7990 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7991 @end enumerate
7992
7993 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7994
7995 @example
7996 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7997 # are optional parameters
7998 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7999 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8000
8001 # binary files need the flash address passing
8002 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8003 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8004 @end example
8005
8006 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8007 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8008 @cindex PLD
8009 @cindex FPGA
8010
8011 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8012 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8013 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8014 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8015 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8016 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8017 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8018
8019 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8020
8021 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8022 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8023 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8024
8025 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8026 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8027
8028 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8029 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8030 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8031 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8032 behavior.
8033 @end deffn
8034
8035 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8036 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8037 @end deffn
8038
8039 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8040 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8041 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8042 @end deffn
8043
8044 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8045
8046 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8047 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8048 that particular type of PLD.
8049
8050 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8051 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8052 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8053
8054 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8055 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8056 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8057
8058 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8059 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8060 for FPGA @var{num}.
8061 @end deffn
8062 @end deffn
8063
8064 @node General Commands
8065 @chapter General Commands
8066 @cindex commands
8067
8068 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8069 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8070 commands are documented elsewhere.
8071
8072 Intent:
8073 @itemize @bullet
8074 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8075 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8076 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8077 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8078
8079 @item @b{From the human}
8080 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8081 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8082
8083 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8084 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8085 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8086
8087 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8088 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8089 port is 5555.
8090 @end itemize
8091
8092
8093 @section Server Commands
8094
8095 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8096 Exits the current telnet session.
8097 @end deffn
8098
8099 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8100 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8101 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8102 Not every command provides helptext.
8103
8104 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8105 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8106 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8107 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8108 @end deffn
8109
8110 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8111 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8112 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8113 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8114 Useful in connection with script files
8115 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8116 @end deffn
8117
8118 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8119 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8120 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8121 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8122
8123 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8124 @example
8125 # redefine shutdown
8126 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8127 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8128 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8129 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8130 original_shutdown
8131 @}
8132 @end example
8133 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8134 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8135 @end deffn
8136
8137 @anchor{debuglevel}
8138 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8139 @cindex message level
8140 Display debug level.
8141 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8142 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8143 Level 0 is error messages only;
8144 level 1 adds warnings;
8145 level 2 adds informational messages;
8146 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8147 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8148 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8149 the command line along with the location of that log
8150 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8151 @xref{Running}.
8152 @end deffn
8153
8154 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8155 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8156 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8157 @example
8158 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8159 @end example
8160 @end deffn
8161
8162 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8163 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8164 the default log output channel is stderr.
8165 @end deffn
8166
8167 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8168 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8169 @end deffn
8170
8171 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8172 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8173 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8174 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8175 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8176 @end deffn
8177
8178 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8179 @section Target State handling
8180 @cindex reset
8181 @cindex halt
8182 @cindex target initialization
8183
8184 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8185 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8186 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8187 a current target which is used to perform the
8188 various operations. The current target may be changed
8189 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8190 target which should become current.
8191
8192 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8193 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8194 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8195 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8196 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8197
8198 @emph{With no arguments}:
8199 list all available registers for the current target,
8200 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8201 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8202 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8203 are flagged as such.
8204
8205 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8206 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8207 bypassing any internal cache.
8208
8209 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8210 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8211 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8212 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8213 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8214 relevant module will flush such values.
8215
8216 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8217 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8218
8219 @example
8220 > reg
8221 ===== ARM registers
8222 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8223 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8224 (2) r2 (/32)
8225 ...
8226 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8227 >
8228 @end example
8229 @end deffn
8230
8231 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8232 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8233 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8234 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8235 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8236 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8237 (and enter debug mode).
8238 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8239
8240 @quotation Warning
8241 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8242 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8243 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8244 power mode by gating the core clock;
8245 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8246
8247 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8248 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8249 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8250 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8251 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8252 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8253
8254 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8255 work with a JTAG debugger.
8256 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8257 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8258 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8259 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8260 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8261 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8262 @end quotation
8263
8264 @end deffn
8265
8266 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8267 Resume the target at its current code position,
8268 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8269 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8270 @end deffn
8271
8272 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8273 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8274 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8275 @end deffn
8276
8277 @anchor{resetcommand}
8278 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8279 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8280 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8281 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8282 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8283 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8284 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8285
8286 The optional parameter specifies what should
8287 happen after the reset.
8288 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8289 The other options will not work on all systems.
8290 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8291
8292 @itemize @minus
8293 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8294 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8295 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8296 @end itemize
8297 @end deffn
8298
8299 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8300 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8301 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8302 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8303 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8304 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8305 state.
8306 @end deffn
8307
8308 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8309 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8310 Set values of reset signals.
8311 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8312 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8313 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8314 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8315
8316 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8317 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8318 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8319 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8320 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8321 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8322 the signal will not be modified.
8323
8324 @quotation Note
8325 TRST is specially handled.
8326 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8327 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8328 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8329 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8330 instead of the TRST signal.
8331 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8332 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8333 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8334 with handlers for that event.
8335 @end quotation
8336 @end deffn
8337
8338 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8339 @section Memory access commands
8340 @cindex memory access
8341
8342 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8343 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8344 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8345 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8346
8347 @enumerate
8348 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8349 to change the current target.
8350 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8351 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8352 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8353 @end enumerate
8354
8355 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8356 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8357 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8358 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8359 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8360 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8361 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8362 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8363 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8364 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8365 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8366 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8367 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8368 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8369 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8370 @end deffn
8371
8372 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8373 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8374 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8375 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8376 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8377 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8378 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8379 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8380 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8381 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8382 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8383 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8384 @end deffn
8385
8386 @anchor{imageaccess}
8387 @section Image loading commands
8388 @cindex image loading
8389 @cindex image dumping
8390
8391 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8392 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8393 binary file named @var{filename}.
8394 @end deffn
8395
8396 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8397 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8398 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8399 @end deffn
8400
8401 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8402 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8403 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8404 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8405 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8406 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8407 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8408 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8409 separately.
8410 @end deffn
8411
8412 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8413 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8414 The file format may optionally be specified
8415 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8416 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8417 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8418 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8419 @example
8420 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8421 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8422 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8423 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8424 $address $length
8425 @}
8426 @end example
8427 @end deffn
8428
8429 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8430 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8431 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8432 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8433 The file format may optionally be specified
8434 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8435 @end deffn
8436
8437 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8438 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8439 The file format may optionally be specified
8440 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8441 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8442 @end deffn
8443
8444 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8445 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8446 The file format may optionally be specified
8447 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8448 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8449 @end deffn
8450
8451
8452 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8453 @cindex breakpoint
8454 @cindex watchpoint
8455
8456 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8457 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8458 watchpoints.
8459 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8460
8461 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8462 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8463 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8464 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8465 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8466 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8467
8468 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8469 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8470 @end deffn
8471
8472 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8473 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8474 @end deffn
8475
8476 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8477 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8478 @end deffn
8479
8480 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8481 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8482 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8483 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8484 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8485 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8486 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8487 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8488 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8489 @end deffn
8490
8491
8492 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8493
8494 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8495 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8496 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8497 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8498 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8499 running, can be used.
8500 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8501 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8502 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8503
8504 @quotation Note
8505 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8506 @end quotation
8507
8508 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8509 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8510 communication, respectively.
8511
8512 @quotation Note
8513 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8514 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8515 example.
8516 @end quotation
8517
8518 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8519 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8520 of TCP/IP connections.
8521
8522 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8523 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8524 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8525 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8526 @var{size} bytes.
8527 @end deffn
8528
8529 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8530 Start RTT.
8531 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8532 @end deffn
8533
8534 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8535 Stop RTT.
8536 @end deffn
8537
8538 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8539 Display the polling interval.
8540 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8541 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8542 checked for new data.
8543 @end deffn
8544
8545 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8546 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8547 @end deffn
8548
8549 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8550 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8551 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8552 @end deffn
8553
8554 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8555 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8556 @end deffn
8557
8558 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8559 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8560 @end deffn
8561
8562 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8563 on the target device.
8564
8565 @example
8566 resume
8567
8568 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8569 rtt start
8570
8571 rtt server start 9090 0
8572 @end example
8573
8574 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8575 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8576 TCP/IP port 9090.
8577
8578
8579 @section Misc Commands
8580
8581 @cindex profiling
8582 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8583 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8584 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8585 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8586 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8587 limit the address range.
8588 @end deffn
8589
8590 @deffn {Command} {version}
8591 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8592 @end deffn
8593
8594 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8595 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8596 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8597 @end deffn
8598
8599 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8600 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8601 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8602 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8603
8604 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8605 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8606 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8607 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8608
8609 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8610 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8611 @cindex tracing
8612 @cindex ETM
8613 @cindex ETB
8614
8615 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8616 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8617 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8618
8619 @itemize
8620 @item
8621 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8622 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8623 supports such an interface.
8624 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8625 and trace port support.)
8626 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8627 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8628 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8629 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8630 in the board-specific configuration file.
8631 @item
8632 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8633 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8634 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8635 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8636 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8637 @end itemize
8638
8639 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8640
8641 @quotation Issues
8642 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8643 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8644
8645 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8646 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8647 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8648 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8649 dummy trace port driver}.
8650
8651 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8652 as well as tracing only during specific states
8653 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8654
8655 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8656 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8657 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8658 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8659 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8660
8661 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8662 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8663 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8664 this original style of JTAG access.
8665 @end quotation
8666
8667 @subsection ETM Configuration
8668 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8669
8670 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8671 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8672 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8673
8674 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8675 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8676 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8677 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8678 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8679 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8680 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8681 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8682 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8683
8684 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8685 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8686 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8687
8688 @quotation Warning
8689 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8690 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8691 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8692 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8693 @end quotation
8694
8695 @quotation Note
8696 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8697 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8698 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8699 what CPU activities are traced.
8700 @end quotation
8701 @end deffn
8702
8703 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8704 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8705 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8706 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8707 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8708 @end deffn
8709
8710 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8711 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8712 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8713 Did trace data overflow?
8714 Was it triggered?
8715 @end deffn
8716
8717 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8718 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8719 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8720 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8721 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8722
8723 @itemize
8724 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8725 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8726 The value is one of
8727 @option{none} (save nothing),
8728 @option{data} (save data),
8729 @option{address} (save addresses),
8730 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8731 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8732 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8733 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8734 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8735 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8736 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8737 trace stream without an image of the code.
8738 @end itemize
8739 @end deffn
8740
8741 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8742 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8743 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8744 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8745 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8746
8747 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8748 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8749 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8750 @end deffn
8751
8752 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8753
8754 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8755 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8756 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8757
8758 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8759 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8760 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8761 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8762 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8763 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8764 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8765
8766 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8767
8768 @itemize
8769 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8770 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8771 for instruction access within that function's body.
8772 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8773 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8774 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8775 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8776 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8777 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8778 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8779 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8780 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8781 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8782 @item @emph{... more}
8783 @end itemize
8784
8785 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8786 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8787
8788 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8789 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8790 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8791 @end deffn
8792
8793 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8794 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8795 @end deffn
8796
8797 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8798 Opens an image file.
8799 @end deffn
8800
8801 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8802 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8803 @end deffn
8804
8805 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8806 Starts trace data collection.
8807 @end deffn
8808
8809 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8810 Stops trace data collection.
8811 @end deffn
8812
8813 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8814 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8815
8816 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8817
8818 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8819 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8820 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8821 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8822 any trace data collection.}
8823 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8824 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8825 @end deffn
8826 @end deffn
8827
8828 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8829 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8830 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8831 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8832 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8833 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8834 @end deffn
8835 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8836 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8837 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8838 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8839 trace trigger becomes active.
8840
8841 @itemize
8842 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8843 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8844 afterwards.
8845 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8846 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8847 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8848 what caused that event to happen.
8849 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8850 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8851 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8852 how the event caused trouble.
8853 @end itemize
8854 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8855 @end deffn
8856
8857 @end deffn
8858
8859 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8860 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8861 @cindex CTI
8862
8863 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8864 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8865 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8866 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8867 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8868 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8869
8870 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8871 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8872 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8873 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8874 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8875 including additional configuration.
8876 @end deffn
8877
8878 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8879 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8880 @end deffn
8881
8882 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
8883 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8884 @end deffn
8885
8886 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8887 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8888 @end deffn
8889
8890 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8891 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8892 @end deffn
8893
8894 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8895 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8896 @end deffn
8897
8898 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8899 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8900 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8901 @end deffn
8902
8903 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8904 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8905 of the CTI.
8906 @end deffn
8907
8908 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
8909 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8910 useful in TCL scripting.
8911 @end deffn
8912
8913 @section Generic ARM
8914 @cindex ARM
8915
8916 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8917 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8918 commands that may be available.
8919
8920 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8921 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8922 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8923 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8924 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8925 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8926 @end deffn
8927
8928 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8929 @cindex disassemble
8930 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8931 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8932 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8933 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8934 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8935 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8936 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8937
8938 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8939 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8940 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8941 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8942 with a handful of exceptions.
8943 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8944 @end deffn
8945
8946 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8947 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8948 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8949 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8950 and using the MCR instruction.
8951 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8952 an ARM register.)
8953 @end deffn
8954
8955 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8956 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8957 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8958 and the MRC instruction.
8959 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8960 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8961 an ARM register.)
8962 @end deffn
8963
8964 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
8965 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8966 core mode if necessary.
8967 @end deffn
8968
8969 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8970 @cindex ARM semihosting
8971 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8972
8973 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8974 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8975 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8976 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8977 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8978 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8979 @end deffn
8980
8981 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8982 @cindex ARM semihosting
8983 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8984
8985 @example
8986 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8987 @end example
8988
8989 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8990 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8991 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8992 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8993 @end deffn
8994
8995 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8996 @cindex ARM semihosting
8997 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8998 status.
8999
9000 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9001 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9002 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9003 debugger.
9004 @end deffn
9005
9006 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9007 @cindex ARM semihosting
9008 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9009
9010 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9011 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9012 the value returned by the target.
9013
9014 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9015 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9016 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9017 encountering a break.
9018
9019 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9020 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9021 to the debugger.
9022 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9023 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9024 request or equivalent").
9025
9026 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9027 this option (default: disabled).
9028 @end deffn
9029
9030 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9031 @cindex ARMv4
9032 @cindex ARMv5
9033
9034 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9035 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9036 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9037 variant.
9038
9039 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9040 @cindex ARM7
9041 @cindex ARM9
9042
9043 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9044 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9045 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9046 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9047
9048 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9049 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9050 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9051 instead of breakpoints.
9052 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9053
9054 This should be
9055 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9056 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9057 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9058 @end deffn
9059
9060 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9061 @cindex DCC
9062 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9063 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9064 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9065
9066 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9067 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9068 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9069 @end deffn
9070
9071 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9072 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9073 that don't check completion of the operation.
9074 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9075
9076 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9077 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9078 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9079 @end deffn
9080
9081 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9082 @cindex ARM9
9083
9084 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9085 integer processors.
9086 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9087
9088 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9089 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9090 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9091 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9092
9093 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9094 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9095 @cindex vector_catch
9096 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9097 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9098 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9099 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9100 to those hardware vectors.
9101
9102 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9103 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9104 vector catch hardware to intercept
9105 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9106 @option{none} of them,
9107 or a list with one or more of the following:
9108 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9109 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9110 @end deffn
9111
9112 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9113 @cindex ARM920T
9114
9115 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9116 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9117 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9118 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9119 and ARM9 commands.
9120
9121 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9122 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9123 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9124 @end deffn
9125
9126 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9127 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9128 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9129 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9130 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9131 (Not all registers can be written.)
9132 @end deffn
9133
9134 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9135 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9136 @end deffn
9137
9138 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9139 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9140 @end deffn
9141
9142 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9143 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9144
9145 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9146 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9147 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9148 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9149 and ARM9 commands.
9150
9151 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9152 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9153
9154 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9155 Print information about the caches found.
9156 @end deffn
9157
9158 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9159 @cindex ARM966E
9160
9161 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9162 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9163 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9164 and ARM9 commands.
9165
9166 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9167 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9168 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9169 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9170 ARM966E-S TRM.
9171 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9172 as required for BIST support.
9173 @end deffn
9174
9175 @subsection XScale specific commands
9176 @cindex XScale
9177
9178 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9179
9180 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9181 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9182 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9183 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9184 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9185 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9186 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9187
9188 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9189 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9190 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9191 the mini-IC.
9192
9193 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9194 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9195 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9196 code layout in memory:
9197 @example
9198 _vectors:
9199 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9200 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9201 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9202 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9203 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9204 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9205 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9206 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9207 .org 0x100
9208 .long real_reset_vector
9209 .long real_ui_handler
9210 .long real_swi_handler
9211 .long real_pf_abort
9212 .long real_data_abort
9213 .long 0 /* unused */
9214 .long real_irq_handler
9215 .long real_fiq_handler
9216 @end example
9217
9218 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9219 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9220 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9221 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9222 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9223 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9224 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9225 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9226 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9227 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9228 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9229 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9230 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9231 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9232 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9233 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9234 software.
9235
9236 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9237 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9238 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9239 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9240
9241 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9242 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9243 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9244 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9245 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9246 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9247 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9248 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9249 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9250
9251 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9252 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9253
9254 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9255 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9256 @end deffn
9257
9258 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9259 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9260 @end deffn
9261
9262 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9263 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9264 @end deffn
9265
9266 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9267 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9268 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9269 @end deffn
9270
9271 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9272 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9273 @end deffn
9274
9275 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9276 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9277 @end deffn
9278
9279 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9280 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9281 @end deffn
9282
9283 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9284 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9285 @end deffn
9286
9287 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9288 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9289 @end deffn
9290
9291 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9292 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9293 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9294 and modifying how it is emptied.
9295 @end deffn
9296
9297 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9298 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9299 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9300 The image @var{type} may be one of
9301 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9302 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9303 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9304 @end deffn
9305
9306 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9307 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9308 @cindex vector_catch
9309 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9310 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9311
9312 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9313 @example
9314 0x01 Trap Reset
9315 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9316 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9317 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9318 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9319 0x20 reserved
9320 0x40 Trap IRQ
9321 0x80 Trap FIQ
9322 @end example
9323 @end deffn
9324
9325 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9326 @cindex vector_table
9327
9328 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9329 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9330 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9331 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9332 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9333
9334 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9335
9336 @end deffn
9337
9338 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9339 @cindex ARMv6
9340
9341 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9342 @cindex ARM11
9343
9344 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9345 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9346 which is enabled by default.
9347 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9348 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9349 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9350 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9351 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9352 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9353 @end deffn
9354
9355 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9356 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9357 which is enabled by default.
9358 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9359 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9360 @end deffn
9361
9362 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9363 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9364 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9365 they are disabled by default.
9366 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9367 @end deffn
9368
9369 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9370 @cindex vector_catch
9371 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9372 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9373 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9374
9375 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9376 for certain hardware events.
9377 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9378 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9379 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9380 @end deffn
9381
9382 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9383 @cindex ARMv7
9384 @cindex ARMv8
9385
9386 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9387 @cindex Cortex-A
9388
9389 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9390 display information about target caches
9391 @end deffn
9392
9393 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9394 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9395 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9396 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9397 Defaults to 'off'.
9398 @end deffn
9399
9400 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9401 Initialize core debug
9402 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9403 @end deffn
9404
9405 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9406 Display/set the current SMP mode
9407 @end deffn
9408
9409 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9410 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9411 @end deffn
9412
9413 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9414 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9415 @end deffn
9416
9417 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9418 configure l2x cache
9419 @end deffn
9420
9421 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9422 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9423 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9424 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9425 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9426 @end deffn
9427
9428 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9429 @cindex Cortex-R
9430
9431 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r dbginit}
9432 Initialize core debug
9433 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9434 @end deffn
9435
9436 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9437 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9438 @end deffn
9439
9440
9441 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9442 @cindex tracing
9443 @cindex SWO
9444 @cindex SWV
9445 @cindex TPIU
9446
9447 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9448 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9449 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9450 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9451
9452 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9453 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9454 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9455 which causes quite some confusion.
9456 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9457 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9458
9459 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9460 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9461 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9462
9463 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9464 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9465 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9466 @end deffn
9467
9468 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9469 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9470 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9471 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9472
9473 @itemize @bullet
9474 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9475 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9476 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9477 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9478
9479 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9480 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9481 @end itemize
9482 @end deffn
9483
9484 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9485 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9486 @end deffn
9487
9488 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9489 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9490 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9491 at any time after the initialization, too.
9492 @end deffn
9493
9494 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9495 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9496 individually queried, to return its current value.
9497 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9498 @end deffn
9499
9500 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9501 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9502 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9503 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9504
9505 @itemize @bullet
9506 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9507 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9508
9509 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9510 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9511
9512 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9513 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9514
9515 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9516 protocol used for trace data:
9517 @itemize @minus
9518 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9519 data bits (default);
9520 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9521 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9522 @end itemize
9523
9524 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9525 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9526 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9527 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9528 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9529 of the TPIU.
9530
9531 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9532 the destination of the trace data:
9533 @itemize @minus
9534 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9535 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9536 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9537 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9538 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9539 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9540 each connected client;
9541 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9542 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9543 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9544 @end itemize
9545
9546 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9547 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9548 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9549 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9550
9551 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9552 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9553 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9554 maximum supported rate automatically.
9555
9556 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9557 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9558 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9559
9560 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9561 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9562 default value is @var{0}.
9563 @end itemize
9564 @end deffn
9565
9566 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9567 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9568 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9569 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9570 data.
9571 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9572 after the @command{init}.
9573 @end deffn
9574
9575 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9576 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9577 @end deffn
9578
9579
9580
9581 Example usage:
9582 @enumerate
9583 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9584 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9585 enough to:
9586 @example
9587 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9588 ...
9589 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9590 ...
9591 @end example
9592 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9593 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9594 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9595 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9596 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9597 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9598 @example
9599 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9600 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9601 @end example
9602 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9603 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9604 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9605 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9606 @example
9607 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9608 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9609 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9610 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9611 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9612 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9613 @end example
9614 @end enumerate
9615
9616 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9617 @cindex tracing
9618 @cindex SWO
9619 @cindex SWV
9620 @cindex ITM
9621 @cindex ETM
9622
9623 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9624 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9625 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9626 @end deffn
9627
9628 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9629 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9630 @end deffn
9631
9632 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9633 @cindex Cortex-M
9634
9635 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9636 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9637
9638 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9639 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9640 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9641 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9642 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9643 the step command leaves with the core running.
9644
9645 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9646 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9647 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9648 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9649
9650 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9651 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9652 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9653 does.
9654
9655 Default is @option{auto}.
9656 @end deffn
9657
9658 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9659 @cindex vector_catch
9660 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9661 for certain hardware events.
9662
9663 Parameters request interception of
9664 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9665 @option{none} of them,
9666 or one or more of the following:
9667 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9668 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9669 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9670 @option{irq_err},
9671 @option{state_err},
9672 @option{chk_err}, or
9673 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9674 @option{reset}.
9675 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9676 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9677 are mapped to HardFault.
9678 UsageFault checks for
9679 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9680 must also be explicitly enabled.
9681
9682 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9683 @end deffn
9684
9685 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9686 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9687 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9688
9689 @itemize @minus
9690 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9691 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9692 @end itemize
9693
9694 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9695 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9696 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9697 to manually reset the peripherals.
9698 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9699
9700 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9701 instead.
9702 @end deffn
9703
9704 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9705 @cindex ARMv8-A
9706 @cindex aarch64
9707
9708 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9709 Display information about target caches
9710 @end deffn
9711
9712 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9713 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9714 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9715 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9716 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9717 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9718 @end deffn
9719
9720 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9721 @cindex disassemble
9722 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9723 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9724 @end deffn
9725
9726 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9727 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9728 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9729 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9730 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9731 @end deffn
9732
9733 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9734 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9735 @option{on}.
9736 @end deffn
9737
9738 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9739 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9740 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9741 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9742 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9743 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9744 @end deffn
9745
9746 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9747
9748 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9749 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9750
9751 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9752
9753 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9754 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9755 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9756 @end deffn
9757
9758 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9759 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9760 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9761 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9762 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9763 @end deffn
9764
9765 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9766
9767 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9768 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9769 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9770 @end deffn
9771
9772 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9773
9774 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9775 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9776 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9777 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9778 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9779 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9780 can be collected.
9781
9782 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9783 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9784 tooling.
9785
9786 @quotation Issues
9787 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9788 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9789 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9790 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9791
9792 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9793 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9794 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9795 software operation on the CPU.
9796 @end quotation
9797
9798 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9799 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9800 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9801 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9802 @end deffn
9803
9804 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9805 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9806 @end deffn
9807
9808 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9809 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9810 control is disabled.
9811 @end deffn
9812
9813 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9814 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9815 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9816 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9817
9818 Supported trace formats:
9819 @itemize
9820 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9821 timing to be determined.
9822 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9823 addresses.
9824 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9825 @end itemize
9826 @end deffn
9827
9828 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9829 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9830 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9831 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9832
9833 Supported conditions:
9834 @itemize
9835 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9836 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9837 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9838 instruction matches start data and mask.
9839 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9840 instruction matches start data and mask.
9841 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9842 data and mask.
9843 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9844 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9845 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9846 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9847 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9848 @end itemize
9849 @end deffn
9850
9851 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9852 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9853 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9854 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9855
9856 Supported conditions:
9857 @itemize
9858 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9859 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9860 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9861 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9862 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9863 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9864 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9865 data and mask.
9866 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9867 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9868 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9869 @end itemize
9870 @end deffn
9871
9872 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9873 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9874
9875 Supported triggers:
9876 @itemize
9877 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9878 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9879 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9880 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9881 collection.
9882 @end itemize
9883 @end deffn
9884
9885 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9886
9887 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
9888 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9889 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9890 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9891 @end deffn
9892
9893 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
9894 Display trace configuration.
9895 @end deffn
9896
9897 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
9898 Display trace collection status.
9899 @end deffn
9900
9901 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
9902 Start manual trace collection.
9903 @end deffn
9904
9905 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
9906 Stop manual trace collection.
9907 @end deffn
9908
9909 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9910 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9911 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9912 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9913 @option{size} options using DMA.
9914 @end deffn
9915
9916 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9917 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9918 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9919 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9920 @option{size} options using DMA.
9921 @end deffn
9922
9923 @section Intel Architecture
9924
9925 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9926 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9927 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9928 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9929 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9930 @itemize
9931 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9932 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9933 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9934 @end itemize
9935
9936 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9937 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9938 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9939
9940 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
9941 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9942 @end deffn
9943
9944 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
9945 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9946 @end deffn
9947
9948 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
9949 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9950 @end deffn
9951
9952 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
9953 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9954 @end deffn
9955
9956 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
9957 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9958 @end deffn
9959
9960 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
9961 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9962 @end deffn
9963
9964 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9965
9966 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9967 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9968
9969 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9970 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9971 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9972 @end deffn
9973 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9974 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9975
9976 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9977
9978 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9979 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9980 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9981 @end deffn
9982
9983 @subsection Registers commands
9984 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9985 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9986 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9987
9988 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9989
9990 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9991 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9992 and "timer" groups.
9993
9994 @emph{example:}
9995 @example
9996 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9997 @end example
9998
9999
10000 @end deffn
10001 @deffn {Command} {readgroup} (@option{group})
10002 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
10003
10004 @emph{group} can be "system",
10005 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
10006 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
10007 @end deffn
10008
10009 @section RISC-V Architecture
10010
10011 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10012 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10013 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10014 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10015 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10016 implement version 0.11.
10017
10018 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10019
10020 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10021 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10022 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10023
10024 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10025
10026 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10027 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10028 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10029
10030 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10031 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10032 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10033 CSRs.
10034 @end deffn
10035
10036 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10037 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10038 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10039 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10040 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10041 This command must be executed before `init`.
10042 @end deffn
10043
10044 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10045 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10046 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10047 @end deffn
10048
10049 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10050 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10051 deasserted.
10052 @end deffn
10053
10054 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10055 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10056 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10057 @end deffn
10058
10059 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10060 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10061 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10062 @end deffn
10063
10064 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10065 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10066 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10067 on physical memory.
10068 @end deffn
10069
10070 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10071 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10072 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10073 performed on physical memory.
10074 @end deffn
10075
10076 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10077 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10078 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10079 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10080 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10081 race condition problem in your code.
10082
10083 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10084 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10085 @end deffn
10086
10087 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10088 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10089 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10090 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10091 values.
10092
10093 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10094 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10095 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10096 @end deffn
10097
10098 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10099 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10100 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10101 @end deffn
10102
10103 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10104 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10105 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10106 @end deffn
10107
10108 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10109 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10110 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10111 @end deffn
10112
10113 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10114 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10115 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10116 @end deffn
10117
10118 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10119
10120 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10121 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10122 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10123 @example
10124 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10125 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10126 @end example
10127
10128 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10129 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10130 @end deffn
10131
10132 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10133 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10134 @end deffn
10135
10136 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10137
10138 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10139 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10140
10141 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10142 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10143 @end deffn
10144
10145 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10146 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10147 @end deffn
10148
10149 @section ARC Architecture
10150 @cindex ARC
10151
10152 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10153 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10154 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10155 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10156 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10157 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10158 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10159 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10160 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10161 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10162 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10163 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10164 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10165 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10166 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10167
10168
10169 @subsection General ARC commands
10170
10171 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10172
10173 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10174 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10175 arguments:
10176
10177 @itemize @bullet
10178
10179 @item @code{-name} name
10180 @*Name of a register.
10181
10182 @item @code{-num} number
10183 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10184
10185 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10186 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10187
10188 @end itemize
10189
10190 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10191
10192 @itemize @bullet
10193
10194 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10195 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10196 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10197 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10198 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10199 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10200
10201 @item @code{-core}
10202 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10203 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10204 spaces.
10205
10206 @item @code{-bcr}
10207 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10208 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10209 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10210 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10211 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10212
10213 @item @code{-type} type_name
10214 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10215 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10216
10217 @item @code{-g}
10218 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10219 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10220 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10221 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10222 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10223
10224 @end itemize
10225
10226 @end deffn
10227
10228 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10229 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10230 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10231 @end deffn
10232
10233 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10234 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10235 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10236 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10237 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10238 startbit endbit}.
10239 @end deffn
10240
10241 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10242 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10243 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10244 @end deffn
10245
10246 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10247 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10248 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10249 @end deffn
10250
10251 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10252
10253 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10254 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10255 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10256 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10257
10258 @end deffn
10259
10260 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10261 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10262 registers.
10263 @end deffn
10264
10265 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10266 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10267 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10268 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10269
10270 @end deffn
10271
10272 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10273 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10274 registers.
10275 @end deffn
10276
10277 @section STM8 Architecture
10278 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10279 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10280
10281 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10282 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10283
10284 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10285 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10286 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10287 @cindex tracing
10288 @cindex libdcc
10289 @cindex DCC
10290 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10291 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10292 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10293 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10294
10295 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10296 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10297 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10298 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10299 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10300 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10301
10302 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10303 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10304 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10305 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10306 The target being debugged may
10307 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10308 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10309 each supported by a command:
10310
10311 @itemize
10312 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10313 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10314 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10315 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10316
10317 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10318 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10319 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10320
10321 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10322 and then displayed at any time.
10323 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10324
10325 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10326 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10327 @end itemize
10328
10329 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10330 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10331 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10332 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10333 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10334 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10335 does the same thing.
10336
10337 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10338 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10339 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10340 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10341 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10342
10343 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10344 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10345 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10346 @end deffn
10347
10348 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10349 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10350 in the order they triggered.
10351 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10352 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10353 history records.
10354 @end deffn
10355
10356 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10357 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10358 they have been triggered.
10359 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10360 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10361 and associates it with that identifier.
10362
10363 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10364 are not related except by this command.
10365 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10366 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10367 @end deffn
10368
10369
10370 @node JTAG Commands
10371 @chapter JTAG Commands
10372 @cindex JTAG Commands
10373 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10374 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10375 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10376 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10377 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10378
10379 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10380 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10381
10382 @itemize @bullet
10383 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10384 devices such as a CPUs.
10385 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10386 standard state machine (in parallel)
10387 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10388 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10389 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10390 while the reading previous ones.
10391 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10392 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10393 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10394 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10395 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10396 registers.
10397 @end itemize
10398
10399 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10400
10401 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10402 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10403 the order of TAP state transitions.
10404 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10405 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10406 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10407 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10408 these commands are not available.
10409
10410 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10411 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10412 that specify the entire register.
10413 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10414 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10415 The return value holds the original value of each
10416 of those fields.
10417
10418 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10419 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10420 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10421 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10422 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10423
10424 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10425 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10426
10427 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10428 in that state.
10429 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10430 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10431 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10432
10433 @quotation Warning
10434 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10435 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10436 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10437 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10438 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10439 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10440 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10441 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10442 @end quotation
10443 @end deffn
10444
10445 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10446 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10447 This may be used for performance tuning.
10448
10449 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10450 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10451 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10452 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10453 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10454 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10455 @end deffn
10456
10457 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10458 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10459 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10460 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10461 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10462 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10463
10464 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10465 in that state.
10466 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10467 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10468 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10469
10470 @quotation Note
10471 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10472 register values, unlike data register values.
10473 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10474 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10475 @end quotation
10476 @end deffn
10477
10478 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10479 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10480 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10481 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10482 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10483 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10484 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10485 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10486 The final state must also be stable.
10487 @end deffn
10488
10489 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10490 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10491 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10492 Instructions often need some time
10493 to execute before they take effect.
10494 @end deffn
10495
10496 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10497 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10498
10499 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10500 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10501 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10502 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10503 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10504 @end deffn
10505
10506 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10507 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10508 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10509 must also be enabled.
10510 Default is enabled.
10511 @end deffn
10512
10513 @section TAP state names
10514 @cindex TAP state names
10515
10516 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10517 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10518 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10519 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10520
10521 @itemize @bullet
10522 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10523 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10524 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10525 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10526 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10527 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10528 through the data register
10529 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10530 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10531 for update or more shifting
10532 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10533 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10534 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10535 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10536 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10537 through the instruction register
10538 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10539 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10540 for update or more shifting
10541 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10542 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10543 @end itemize
10544
10545 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10546 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10547 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10548 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10549
10550 @itemize @bullet
10551 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10552 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10553 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10554 may not be as expected.
10555 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10556 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10557 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10558 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10559 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10560 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10561 @end itemize
10562
10563 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10564 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10565
10566 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10567 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10568 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10569 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10570
10571 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10572 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10573 @cindex SVF
10574
10575 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10576 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10577 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10578 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10579
10580 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10581 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10582 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10583 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10584
10585 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10586 affect their semantics.
10587
10588 Command options:
10589 @itemize @minus
10590 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10591 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10592 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10593 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10594 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10595 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10596 on the real interface;
10597 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10598 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10599 errors.
10600 @end itemize
10601 @end deffn
10602
10603 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10604 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10605 @cindex XSVF
10606
10607 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10608 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10609 Xilinx devices.
10610 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10611 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10612
10613 @quotation Important
10614 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10615 @end quotation
10616
10617 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10618 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10619 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10620 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10621 that TAP.
10622 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10623 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10624 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10625 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10626 @end deffn
10627
10628 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10629 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10630 after building the software.
10631 You may find them useful:
10632
10633 @itemize
10634 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10635 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10636 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10637 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10638 @end itemize
10639
10640 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10641 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10642 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10643 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10644 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10645 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10646 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10647
10648
10649 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10650 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10651 @cindex IPDBG
10652
10653 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10654 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10655 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10656 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10657 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10658 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10659
10660 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10661 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10662
10663 Command options:
10664 @itemize @bullet
10665 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10666 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10667 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10668 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10669 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10670 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10671 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10672 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10673 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10674 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10675 shift data through vir can be configured.
10676 @end itemize
10677 @end deffn
10678
10679 Examples:
10680 @example
10681 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10682 @end example
10683 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10684 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10685
10686 @example
10687 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10688 @end example
10689 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10690 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10691
10692 @node Utility Commands
10693 @chapter Utility Commands
10694 @cindex Utility Commands
10695
10696 @section RAM testing
10697 @cindex RAM testing
10698
10699 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10700 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10701 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10702 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10703 hardware problems.
10704
10705 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10706 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10707 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10708 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10709
10710 Load the memory testing functions with
10711
10712 @example
10713 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10714 @end example
10715
10716 to get access to the following facilities:
10717
10718 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10719 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10720 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10721 @end deffn
10722
10723 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10724 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10725 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10726 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10727 @end deffn
10728
10729 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10730 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10731 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10732 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10733 @end deffn
10734
10735 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10736 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10737 @end deffn
10738
10739 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10740 @cindex Firmware recovery
10741
10742 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10743 devices recovery with JTAG.
10744
10745 For quickstart instructions run:
10746 @example
10747 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10748 @end example
10749
10750 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10751 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10752 @cindex GDB
10753 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10754 to debug remote targets.
10755 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10756
10757 @itemize
10758 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10759 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10760 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10761 as shown in this chapter.
10762 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10763 that also will probably need to be configured.
10764 @end itemize
10765
10766 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10767 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10768 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10769 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10770 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10771 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10772
10773 @section Connecting to GDB
10774 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10775 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10776 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10777 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10778 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10779
10780 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10781
10782 @enumerate
10783 @item
10784 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10785 @example
10786 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10787 @end example
10788 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10789
10790 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10791 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10792 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10793
10794 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10795 remote command above that becomes:
10796 @example
10797 tar ext :3333
10798 @end example
10799
10800 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10801 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10802 available through the command:
10803 @example
10804 target remote localhost:3333
10805 @end example
10806
10807 @item
10808 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10809 @example
10810 target extended-remote | \
10811 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10812 @end example
10813 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10814 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10815 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10816 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10817 @end enumerate
10818
10819 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10820 GDB command line.
10821
10822 @section Sample GDB session startup
10823
10824 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10825 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10826 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10827 small ARM program.
10828 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10829 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10830
10831 @example
10832 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10833 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10834 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10835 ...
10836 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10837 ...
10838 (gdb) load
10839 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10840 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10841 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10842 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10843 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10844 (gdb) continue
10845 Continuing.
10846 ...
10847 @end example
10848
10849 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10850 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10851 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10852 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10853
10854 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10855
10856 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10857 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10858 packet size and the device's memory map.
10859 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10860 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10861 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10862
10863 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10864 You may need to set those up by hand.
10865 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10866 something like:
10867
10868 @example
10869 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10870 @end example
10871
10872 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10873
10874 @example
10875 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10876 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10877 @end example
10878
10879 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10880 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10881 do not have such restrictions.
10882
10883 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10884 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10885 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10886 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10887
10888 @section Programming using GDB
10889 @cindex Programming using GDB
10890 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10891
10892 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10893 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10894 @example
10895 gdb_memory_map disable
10896 @end example
10897 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10898 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10899 working area.
10900
10901 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10902 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10903 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10904 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10905
10906 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10907 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10908
10909 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10910 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10911 @example
10912 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10913 @end example
10914
10915 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10916 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10917
10918 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10919 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10920 will be used.
10921
10922 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10923 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10924 @example
10925 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10926 @end example
10927 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10928
10929 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10930 can be used.
10931
10932 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10933 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10934 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10935
10936 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10937 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10938 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10939
10940 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10941 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10942 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10943 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10944 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10945 without any intrusion of the target process.
10946
10947 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10948 Place following command after target configuration:
10949 @example
10950 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10951 @end example
10952
10953 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10954 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10955 @example
10956 gdb_memory_map disable
10957 @end example
10958
10959 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10960 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10961 @example
10962 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10963 @end example
10964
10965 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10966 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10967
10968 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10969 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10970 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10971 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10972
10973 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10974 previously shown variables.
10975
10976 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
10977 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
10978 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
10979 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
10980 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
10981
10982 @section RTOS Support
10983 @cindex RTOS Support
10984 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10985
10986 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10987 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10988
10989 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10990 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10991 GDB commands.
10992
10993 @* An example setup is below:
10994
10995 @example
10996 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10997 @end example
10998
10999 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11000
11001 Currently supported rtos's include:
11002 @itemize @bullet
11003 @item @option{eCos}
11004 @item @option{ThreadX}
11005 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11006 @item @option{linux}
11007 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11008 @item @option{embKernel}
11009 @item @option{mqx}
11010 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11011 @item @option{nuttx}
11012 @item @option{RIOT}
11013 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11014 @item @option{Zephyr}
11015 @end itemize
11016
11017 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11018 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11019
11020 @table @code
11021 @item eCos symbols
11022 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11023 @item ThreadX symbols
11024 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11025 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11026 @raggedright
11027 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11028 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11029 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11030 @end raggedright
11031 @item linux symbols
11032 init_task.
11033 @item ChibiOS symbols
11034 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11035 @item embKernel symbols
11036 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11037 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11038 @item mqx symbols
11039 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11040 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11041 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11042 @item nuttx symbols
11043 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11044 @item RIOT symbols
11045 @raggedright
11046 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11047 _tcb_name_offset.
11048 @end raggedright
11049 @item Zephyr symbols
11050 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11051 @end table
11052
11053 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11054 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11055
11056 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11057 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11058
11059 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11060 along with the project:
11061
11062 @table @code
11063 @item FreeRTOS
11064 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11065 @item uC/OS-III
11066 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11067 @end table
11068
11069 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11070 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11071 @cindex SMP
11072 @cindex RTOS
11073 @cindex hwthread
11074 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11075 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11076 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11077 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11078 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11079 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11080 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11081 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11082 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11083
11084 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11085 @quotation Note
11086 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11087 @end quotation
11088
11089 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11090 @itemize @bullet
11091 @item j - smp status request
11092 @item J - smp set request
11093 @end itemize
11094
11095 OpenOCD implements :
11096 @itemize @bullet
11097 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11098 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11099 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11100 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11101 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11102 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11103 @end itemize
11104
11105 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11106 @itemize @bullet
11107 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11108 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11109 @example
11110 set $_core 1
11111 #Jc01 packet is sent
11112 print $_core
11113 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11114 @end example
11115
11116 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11117 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11118
11119 @example
11120 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11121 define toggle0
11122 maint packet Jc0
11123 continue
11124 main packet Jc-1
11125 end
11126 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11127 define toggle1
11128 maint packet Jc1
11129 continue
11130 main packet Jc-1
11131 end
11132 @end example
11133 @end itemize
11134
11135 @node Tcl Scripting API
11136 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11137 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11138 @cindex Tcl scripts
11139 @section API rules
11140
11141 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11142 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11143 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11144
11145 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11146 pair list and lists.
11147
11148 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11149 list.
11150
11151 @example
11152 > set foo(me) Duane
11153 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11154 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11155 > set foo(duck) Donald
11156 @end example
11157
11158 If one does this:
11159
11160 @example
11161 > set foo
11162 @end example
11163
11164 The result is:
11165
11166 @example
11167 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11168 @end example
11169
11170 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11171
11172 @verbatim
11173 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11174 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11175 }
11176 @end verbatim
11177
11178 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11179 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11180
11181 @section Internal low-level Commands
11182
11183 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11184 invoke directly.
11185
11186 @itemize @bullet
11187 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11188
11189 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11190 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11191
11192 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11193 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11194
11195 Return information about the flash banks
11196
11197 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11198
11199 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11200 its execution. Example:
11201
11202 @example
11203 > capture "reset init"
11204 @end example
11205
11206 @end itemize
11207
11208 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11209 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11210 called "flash_banks".
11211
11212 @section Tcl RPC server
11213 @cindex RPC
11214
11215 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11216 commands and receive the results.
11217
11218 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11219 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11220 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11221 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11222 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11223
11224 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11225 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11226 @command{capture} command.
11227
11228 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11229
11230 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11231 @cindex RPC Notifications
11232
11233 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11234 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11235
11236 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11237 in the following format.
11238
11239 @verbatim
11240 type target_event event [event-name]
11241 type target_state state [state-name]
11242 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11243 @end verbatim
11244
11245 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11246 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11247 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11248 Defaults to off.
11249
11250 @end deffn
11251
11252 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11253 @cindex RPC trace output
11254
11255 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11256 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11257
11258 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11259
11260 @verbatim
11261 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11262 @end verbatim
11263
11264 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11265 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11266 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11267 Defaults to off.
11268
11269 See an example application here:
11270 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11271
11272 @end deffn
11273
11274 @node FAQ
11275 @chapter FAQ
11276 @cindex faq
11277 @enumerate
11278 @anchor{faqrtck}
11279 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11280 @cindex RTCK
11281 @cindex adaptive clocking
11282 @*
11283
11284 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11285 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11286 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11287 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11288
11289 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11290 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11291 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11292 @enumerate
11293 @item
11294 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11295 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11296 @item
11297 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11298 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11299 @end enumerate
11300
11301 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11302 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11303 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11304 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11305 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11306 power).
11307
11308 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11309 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11310 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11311 ARM926 scenario).
11312 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11313 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11314 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11315
11316 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11317 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11318 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11319 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11320
11321 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11322
11323 In order to make use of this,
11324 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11325 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11326
11327 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11328 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11329 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11330 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11331 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11332
11333 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11334 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11335 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11336 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11337
11338 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11339 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11340 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11341 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11342 with a CPLD.
11343 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11344 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11345 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11346 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11347 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11348 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11349
11350 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11351
11352 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11353
11354 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11355 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11356 depending on the chips on your board.
11357 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11358 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11359 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11360
11361 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11362 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11363 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11364
11365 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11366 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11367 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11368 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11369
11370 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11371 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11372 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11373 this way.
11374
11375 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11376 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11377 clock rate.
11378 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11379 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11380 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11381
11382 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11383
11384 @example
11385 # Example: 1.234MHz
11386 adapter speed 1234
11387 @end example
11388
11389
11390 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11391
11392 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11393 around Windows filenames.
11394
11395 @example
11396 > echo \a
11397
11398 > echo @{\a@}
11399 \a
11400 > echo "\a"
11401
11402 >
11403 @end example
11404
11405
11406 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11407
11408 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11409 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11410 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11411
11412 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11413 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11414 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11415
11416 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11417 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11418 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11419
11420 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11421
11422 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11423 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11424 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11425 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11426
11427 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11428 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11429 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11430
11431 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11432 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11433
11434 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11435 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11436 memory read caused data abort".
11437
11438 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11439 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11440 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11441 be done, feel free to add this here.
11442
11443 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11444 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11445 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11446 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11447 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11448 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11449 gracefully stops.
11450
11451 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11452 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11453 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11454
11455 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11456 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11457 bytes. Painful...
11458
11459
11460 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11461 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11462
11463 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11464 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11465 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11466 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11467 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11468 reset, everything else should work fine.
11469
11470 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11471 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11472 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11473 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11474
11475 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11476 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11477 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11478 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11479
11480 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11481
11482 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11483 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11484 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11485
11486 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11487 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11488
11489 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11490 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11491 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11492 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11493 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11494 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11495 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11496 clock frequency?
11497
11498 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11499 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11500 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11501 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11502 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11503
11504 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11505
11506 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11507 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11508 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11509 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11510 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11511 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11512 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11513
11514 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11515
11516 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11517 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11518 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11519 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11520
11521 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11522 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11523 particular order?
11524
11525 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11526 the same order used by the hardware.
11527
11528 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11529 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11530 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11531 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11532 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11533 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11534
11535 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11536 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11537 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11538 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11539
11540 @itemize @bullet
11541 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11542 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11543 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11544 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11545 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11546 @end itemize
11547
11548 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11549
11550 @itemize @bullet
11551 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11552 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11553 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11554 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11555 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11556 @end itemize
11557
11558
11559 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11560 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11561 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11562
11563 TODO.
11564
11565 @end enumerate
11566
11567 @node Tcl Crash Course
11568 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11569 @cindex Tcl
11570
11571 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11572 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11573 how the Tcl scripts work.
11574
11575 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11576 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11577 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11578 OpenOCD.
11579
11580 @section Tcl Rule #1
11581 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11582 @enumerate
11583 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11584 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11585 @end enumerate
11586
11587 The Tcl equal is this:
11588
11589 @enumerate
11590 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11591 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11592 @end enumerate
11593
11594 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11595 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11596
11597 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11598 There is a second pair of rules.
11599 @enumerate
11600 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11601 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11602 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11603 in Tcl.
11604 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11605 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11606 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11607 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11608 @end enumerate
11609
11610 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11611 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11612 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11613 Everything is a string}
11614
11615 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11616 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11617 difference is subtle.
11618 @enumerate
11619 @item Parse Time
11620 @item Evaluation Time
11621 @end enumerate
11622
11623 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11624 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11625 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11626
11627 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11628 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11629 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11630 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11631
11632 @itemize @bullet
11633 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11634 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11635 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11636 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11637 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11638 @example
11639 # bash example
11640 X=`date`
11641 echo "The Date is: $X"
11642 # Tcl example
11643 set X [date]
11644 puts "The Date is: $X"
11645 @end example
11646 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11647 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11648 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11649 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11650 is a string}
11651 @example
11652 set x "Dinner"
11653 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11654 @end example
11655 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11656 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11657 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11658 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11659 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11660 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11661 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11662 @end itemize
11663
11664 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11665
11666 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11667
11668 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11669
11670 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11671 the normal way.
11672
11673 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11674 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11675 line is immediately executed.
11676
11677 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11678 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11679
11680 @subsection Command Execution
11681
11682 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11683 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11684 control flow operators.
11685
11686 Commands are executed like this:
11687
11688 @enumerate
11689 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11690 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11691 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11692 @end enumerate
11693
11694 It sort of works like this:
11695 @example
11696 for(;;)@{
11697 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11698
11699 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11700
11701 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11702 @}
11703 @end example
11704
11705 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11706 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11707 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11708 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11709 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11710 ``LookupCommand()''
11711
11712 @subsection The FOR command
11713
11714 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11715 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11716 command just like any other command.
11717
11718 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11719 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11720 are:
11721
11722 @enumerate 0
11723 @item The ascii text 'for'
11724 @item The start text
11725 @item The test expression
11726 @item The next text
11727 @item The body text
11728 @end enumerate
11729
11730 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11731 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11732 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11733 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11734
11735 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11736 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11737
11738 @example
11739 int
11740 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11741 int *argc,
11742 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11743 @end example
11744
11745 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11746 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11747 still operates in the same basic way.
11748
11749 @subsection FOR command implementation
11750
11751 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11752 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11753
11754 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11755
11756 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11757
11758 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11759 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11760 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11761
11762 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11763 expression and returns a value.
11764
11765 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11766 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11767 @example
11768 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11769
11770 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11771
11772 int
11773 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11774 int argc,
11775 char **argv )
11776 @{
11777 if( argc != 5 )@{
11778 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11779 return ERROR;
11780 @}
11781
11782 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11783
11784 // Execute the start statement.
11785 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11786
11787 // Top of loop test
11788 for(;;)@{
11789 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11790 if( i == 0 )
11791 break;
11792
11793 // Execute the body
11794 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11795
11796 // Execute the LOOP part
11797 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11798 @}
11799
11800 // Return no error
11801 SetResult( interp, "" );
11802 return SUCCESS;
11803 @}
11804 @end example
11805
11806 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11807 in the same basic way.
11808
11809 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11810
11811 @subsection source and find commands
11812 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11813 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11814 @*Remember the parsing rules
11815 @enumerate
11816 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11817 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11818 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11819 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11820 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11821 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11822 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11823 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11824 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11825 @end enumerate
11826 @subsection format command
11827 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11828 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11829 @b{sprintf()}.
11830 @b{Example}
11831 @example
11832 set x 6
11833 set y 7
11834 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11835 @end example
11836 @enumerate
11837 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11838 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11839 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11840 @* Refer to Rule #1
11841 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11842 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11843 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11844 @end enumerate
11845 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11846 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11847 @example
11848 #1 Good
11849 proc someproc @{@} @{
11850 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11851 @}
11852 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11853 #2 Good - no variables
11854 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11855 #3 Good Curly Braces
11856 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11857 puts "Time: [date]"
11858 @}
11859 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11860 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11861 @end example
11862 @enumerate
11863 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11864 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11865 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11866 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11867 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11868 command.
11869 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11870 @*There are 4 examples:
11871 @enumerate
11872 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11873 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11874 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11875 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11876 @end enumerate
11877
11878 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11879 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11880 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11881
11882 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11883 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11884 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11885 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11886 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11887 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11888 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11889 @end enumerate
11890 @subsection Global Variables
11891 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11892 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11893 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11894 @example
11895 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11896 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11897 global x #Global variable X
11898 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11899 @}
11900 @end example
11901 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11902 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11903 @example
11904 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11905 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11906 # Create var name
11907 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11908 # Make it a global
11909 global $vn
11910 # Set it.
11911 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11912 @}
11913 @end example
11914 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11915 @example
11916 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11917 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11918 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11919 @}
11920 @end example
11921
11922 @node License
11923 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
11924 @include fdl.texi
11925
11926 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11927 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11928 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11929 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11930 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11931 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11932
11933 @printindex cp
11934
11935 @node Command and Driver Index
11936 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11937 @printindex fn
11938
11939 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)